1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
27 #include "blockinput.h"
28 #include "syssignal.h"
30 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
31 if this is not done before the other system files. */
33 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
35 /* If we have Xfixes extension, use it for pointer blanking. */
37 #include <X11/extensions/Xfixes.h>
40 /* Using Xft implies that XRender is available. */
42 #include <X11/extensions/Xrender.h>
45 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
46 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
48 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
58 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
59 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
62 #include "character.h"
65 #include "dispextern.h"
67 #include "termhooks.h"
70 #include "emacs-icon.h"
75 #include "intervals.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
86 #include <X11/Shell.h>
94 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
98 #if defined (USE_LUCID) || defined (USE_MOTIF)
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
103 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget
, XtPointer
, XEvent
*, Boolean
*);
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* For LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
139 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
142 #include <X11/XKBlib.h>
145 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
149 bool use_xim
= false; /* configure --without-xim */
152 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
155 static bool any_help_event_p
;
157 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
160 struct x_display_info
*x_display_list
;
164 /* The application context for Xt use. */
165 XtAppContext Xt_app_con
;
166 static String Xt_default_resources
[] = {0};
168 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
169 static bool toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
;
171 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
173 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
174 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
175 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
177 static Time ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
;
179 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
181 static int x_noop_count
;
184 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
185 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file
;
188 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
189 static char emacs_class
[] = EMACS_CLASS
;
193 XEMBED_MAPPED
= 1 << 0
198 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY
= 0,
199 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE
= 1,
200 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE
= 2,
201 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
= 3,
203 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT
= 5,
204 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT
= 6,
205 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV
= 7,
207 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON
= 10,
208 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF
= 11,
209 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR
= 12,
210 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR
= 13,
211 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR
= 14
214 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display
*, Colormap
, XColor
*);
215 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame
*, bool, int, int, bool);
216 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame
*);
217 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame
*);
218 static const XColor
*x_color_cells (Display
*, int *);
219 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display
*);
220 static struct terminal
*x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info
*);
221 static void x_update_end (struct frame
*);
222 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame
*);
223 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame
*);
224 static _Noreturn
void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame
*, int, int);
225 static void frame_highlight (struct frame
*);
226 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame
*);
227 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info
*, struct frame
*);
228 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info
*,
229 struct frame
*, struct input_event
*);
230 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame
*);
231 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info
*);
232 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*);
233 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*, int,
234 enum text_cursor_kinds
);
236 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*,
237 enum glyph_row_area
, GC
);
238 static void x_flush (struct frame
*f
);
239 static void x_update_begin (struct frame
*);
240 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window
*);
241 static struct scroll_bar
*x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display
*, Window
, int);
242 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**, Lisp_Object
*,
243 enum scroll_bar_part
*,
244 Lisp_Object
*, Lisp_Object
*,
246 static void x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**, Lisp_Object
*,
247 enum scroll_bar_part
*,
248 Lisp_Object
*, Lisp_Object
*,
250 static bool x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame
*, const XPropertyEvent
*);
251 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame
*);
252 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame
*, int, int);
253 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame
*, int, int, bool);
254 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info
*,
255 const XEvent
*, int *,
256 struct input_event
*);
257 #if ! (defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_MOTIF)
258 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent
*, Display
*);
260 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
261 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
262 static void x_connection_closed (Display
*, const char *);
263 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame
*, int);
264 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame
*, ptrdiff_t);
265 static void x_initialize (void);
267 static bool get_current_wm_state (struct frame
*, Window
, int *, bool *);
269 /* Flush display of frame F. */
272 x_flush (struct frame
*f
)
274 eassert (f
&& FRAME_X_P (f
));
275 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
276 connection may be broken. */
277 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay
))
281 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
286 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
287 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
288 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
289 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
290 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
293 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
296 /***********************************************************************
298 ***********************************************************************/
302 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
303 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
311 struct record event_record
[100];
313 int event_record_index
;
316 record_event (char *locus
, int type
)
318 if (event_record_index
== ARRAYELTS (event_record
))
319 event_record_index
= 0;
321 event_record
[event_record_index
].locus
= locus
;
322 event_record
[event_record_index
].type
= type
;
323 event_record_index
++;
330 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
332 struct x_display_info
*
333 x_display_info_for_display (Display
*dpy
)
335 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
337 for (dpyinfo
= x_display_list
; dpyinfo
; dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
)
338 if (dpyinfo
->display
== dpy
)
345 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame
*f
)
347 struct x_output
*x
= f
->output_data
.x
;
348 Window win
= None
, wi
= x
->parent_desc
;
349 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
351 while (wi
!= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
)
355 unsigned int nchildren
;
358 if (XQueryTree (dpy
, win
, &root
, &wi
, &children
, &nchildren
))
367 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
370 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame
*f
)
372 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
373 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
374 Window win
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
376 double alpha_min
= 1.0;
380 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
385 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
))
386 alpha_min
= XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
);
387 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
))
388 alpha_min
= (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
)) / 100.0;
392 else if (alpha
> 1.0)
394 else if (0.0 <= alpha
&& alpha
< alpha_min
&& alpha_min
<= 1.0)
397 opac
= alpha
* OPAQUE
;
399 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
401 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
402 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
403 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
404 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
406 parent
= x_find_topmost_parent (f
);
408 XChangeProperty (dpy
, parent
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
409 XA_CARDINAL
, 32, PropModeReplace
,
410 (unsigned char *) &opac
, 1);
412 /* return unless necessary */
417 unsigned long n
, left
;
419 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, win
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
420 0, 1, False
, XA_CARDINAL
,
421 &actual
, &format
, &n
, &left
,
424 if (rc
== Success
&& actual
!= None
)
426 unsigned long value
= *(unsigned long *)data
;
436 XChangeProperty (dpy
, win
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
437 XA_CARDINAL
, 32, PropModeReplace
,
438 (unsigned char *) &opac
, 1);
442 /***********************************************************************
443 Starting and ending an update
444 ***********************************************************************/
446 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
447 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
448 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
449 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
450 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
453 x_update_begin (struct frame
*f
)
459 /* Start update of window W. */
462 x_update_window_begin (struct window
*w
)
464 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
465 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
);
467 w
->output_cursor
= w
->cursor
;
471 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
473 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
474 hlinfo
->mouse_face_defer
= true;
476 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
478 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f
))
479 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
486 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
489 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window
*w
, int x
, int y0
, int y1
)
491 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
494 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID
);
496 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
499 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
500 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, x
, y0
, x
, y1
);
503 /* Draw a window divider from (x0,y0) to (x1,y1) */
506 x_draw_window_divider (struct window
*w
, int x0
, int x1
, int y0
, int y1
)
508 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
509 struct face
*face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, WINDOW_DIVIDER_FACE_ID
);
510 struct face
*face_first
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, WINDOW_DIVIDER_FIRST_PIXEL_FACE_ID
);
511 struct face
*face_last
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, WINDOW_DIVIDER_LAST_PIXEL_FACE_ID
);
512 unsigned long color
= face
? face
->foreground
: FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
);
513 unsigned long color_first
= (face_first
514 ? face_first
->foreground
515 : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
516 unsigned long color_last
= (face_last
517 ? face_last
->foreground
518 : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
519 Display
*display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
520 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
522 if (y1
- y0
> x1
- x0
&& x1
- x0
> 2)
525 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color_first
);
526 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
528 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color
);
529 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
530 x0
+ 1, y0
, x1
- x0
- 2, y1
- y0
);
531 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color_last
);
532 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
533 x1
- 1, y0
, 1, y1
- y0
);
535 else if (x1
- x0
> y1
- y0
&& y1
- y0
> 3)
538 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color_first
);
539 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
541 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color
);
542 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
543 x0
, y0
+ 1, x1
- x0
, y1
- y0
- 2);
544 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color_last
);
545 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
546 x0
, y1
- 1, x1
- x0
, 1);
550 XSetForeground (display
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, color
);
551 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
552 x0
, y0
, x1
- x0
, y1
- y0
);
556 /* End update of window W.
558 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
559 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
561 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
562 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
563 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
565 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
566 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
570 x_update_window_end (struct window
*w
, bool cursor_on_p
,
571 bool mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
573 if (!w
->pseudo_window_p
)
578 display_and_set_cursor (w
, true,
579 w
->output_cursor
.hpos
, w
->output_cursor
.vpos
,
580 w
->output_cursor
.x
, w
->output_cursor
.y
);
582 if (draw_window_fringes (w
, true))
584 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w
))
585 x_draw_right_divider (w
);
587 x_draw_vertical_border (w
);
593 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
594 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
595 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
597 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w
->frame
));
599 hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_col
= -1;
600 hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_col
= -1;
601 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
606 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
610 x_update_end (struct frame
*f
)
612 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
613 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
)->mouse_face_defer
= false;
617 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
623 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c
624 whenever a complete update has been performed. */
627 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame
*f
)
630 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f
);
634 /* Clear under internal border if any (GTK has its own version). */
637 x_clear_under_internal_border (struct frame
*f
)
639 if (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
) > 0)
641 Display
*display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
642 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
643 int border
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
644 int width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
645 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
646 int margin
= FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
);
649 x_clear_area (display
, window
, 0, 0, border
, height
);
650 x_clear_area (display
, window
, 0, margin
, width
, border
);
651 x_clear_area (display
, window
, width
- border
, 0, border
, height
);
652 x_clear_area (display
, window
, 0, height
- border
, width
, border
);
658 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
659 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
660 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. This function is called from
661 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
662 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
665 x_after_update_window_line (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*desired_row
)
669 if (!desired_row
->mode_line_p
&& !w
->pseudo_window_p
)
670 desired_row
->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p
= true;
673 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
674 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
675 check here if updated window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
676 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
677 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
678 overhead is very small. */
683 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
684 && desired_row
->full_width_p
685 && (f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
),
686 width
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
688 && (height
= desired_row
->visible_height
,
691 int y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, desired_row
->y
));
694 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
695 0, y
, width
, height
);
696 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
697 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - width
,
706 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params
*p
)
708 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
709 Display
*display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
710 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
711 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
712 struct face
*face
= p
->face
;
714 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
715 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, ANY_AREA
, gc
);
717 if (p
->bx
>= 0 && !p
->overlay_p
)
719 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
720 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
721 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
722 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
724 XSetFillStyle (display
, face
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
726 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->background
);
728 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, face
->gc
,
729 p
->bx
, p
->by
, p
->nx
, p
->ny
);
732 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->foreground
);
738 Pixmap pixmap
, clipmask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
739 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
));
743 bits
= (char *) (p
->bits
+ p
->dh
);
745 bits
= (char *) p
->bits
+ p
->dh
;
747 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
749 pixmap
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
, window
, bits
, p
->wd
, p
->h
,
751 ? (p
->overlay_p
? face
->background
752 : f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
754 face
->background
, depth
);
758 clipmask
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
,
759 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
,
762 gcv
.clip_mask
= clipmask
;
763 gcv
.clip_x_origin
= p
->x
;
764 gcv
.clip_y_origin
= p
->y
;
765 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
, &gcv
);
768 XCopyArea (display
, pixmap
, window
, gc
, 0, 0,
769 p
->wd
, p
->h
, p
->x
, p
->y
);
770 XFreePixmap (display
, pixmap
);
774 gcv
.clip_mask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
775 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
, &gcv
);
776 XFreePixmap (display
, clipmask
);
780 XSetClipMask (display
, gc
, None
);
783 /***********************************************************************
785 ***********************************************************************/
789 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string
*);
790 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
791 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
792 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
793 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string
*);
794 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*);
795 static _Noreturn
void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame
*, int);
796 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string
*);
797 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
798 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
799 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
800 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame
*, Display
*, Colormap
,
801 unsigned long *, double, int);
802 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame
*, struct relief
*,
803 double, int, unsigned long);
804 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string
*);
805 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*);
806 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string
*);
807 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
808 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string
*, Pixmap
);
809 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string
*, int,
811 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame
*, int, int, int, int,
812 int, bool, bool, bool, bool, bool,
814 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string
*, int, int, int, int,
815 int, bool, bool, XRectangle
*);
816 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame
*);
819 static void x_check_font (struct frame
*, struct font
*);
823 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
827 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
829 if (s
->font
== FRAME_FONT (s
->f
)
830 && s
->face
->background
== FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
831 && s
->face
->foreground
== FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
833 s
->gc
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_gc
;
836 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
840 xgcv
.background
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
841 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
843 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
844 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
845 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
846 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
847 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
;
848 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
849 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
851 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
852 if (xgcv
.background
== s
->face
->background
853 && xgcv
.foreground
== s
->face
->foreground
)
855 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->foreground
;
856 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
859 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s
->f
, s
->font
));
860 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
861 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
863 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
864 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
867 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
868 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
870 s
->gc
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
875 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
878 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
883 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
884 face_id
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (s
->f
)->mouse_face_face_id
;
885 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
887 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, MOUSE_FACE_ID
);
889 if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
890 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, s
->first_glyph
->u
.ch
, -1, Qnil
);
892 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, 0, -1, Qnil
);
893 s
->face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
894 prepare_face_for_display (s
->f
, s
->face
);
896 if (s
->font
== s
->face
->font
)
900 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
905 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->background
;
906 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
907 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
908 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
910 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
911 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
914 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
915 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
917 s
->gc
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
920 eassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
924 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
925 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
926 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
929 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
935 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
936 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
940 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
942 prepare_face_for_display (s
->f
, s
->face
);
944 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
)
947 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
949 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO
)
951 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s
);
952 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
954 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
957 s
->stippled_p
= false;
959 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
)
961 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
962 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
964 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
965 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
968 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
973 /* GC must have been set. */
974 eassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
978 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
979 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
982 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string
*s
)
984 XRectangle
*r
= s
->clip
;
985 int n
= get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s
, r
, 2);
988 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, r
, n
, Unsorted
);
993 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
994 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
998 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string
*src
, struct glyph_string
*dst
)
1003 r
.width
= src
->width
;
1005 r
.height
= src
->height
;
1008 XSetClipRectangles (dst
->display
, dst
->gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
1013 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1016 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1019 && (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
1020 || s
->first_glyph
->type
== COMPOSITE_GLYPH
))
1022 struct font_metrics metrics
;
1024 if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
1026 unsigned *code
= alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s
->nchars
);
1027 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1030 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++)
1031 code
[i
] = (s
->char2b
[i
].byte1
<< 8) | s
->char2b
[i
].byte2
;
1032 font
->driver
->text_extents (font
, code
, s
->nchars
, &metrics
);
1036 Lisp_Object gstring
= composition_gstring_from_id (s
->cmp_id
);
1038 composition_gstring_width (gstring
, s
->cmp_from
, s
->cmp_to
, &metrics
);
1040 s
->right_overhang
= (metrics
.rbearing
> metrics
.width
1041 ? metrics
.rbearing
- metrics
.width
: 0);
1042 s
->left_overhang
= metrics
.lbearing
< 0 ? - metrics
.lbearing
: 0;
1046 s
->right_overhang
= s
->cmp
->rbearing
- s
->cmp
->pixel_width
;
1047 s
->left_overhang
= - s
->cmp
->lbearing
;
1052 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1055 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
, int x
, int y
, int w
, int h
)
1058 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
1059 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
1060 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
1061 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
1065 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1066 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1067 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1068 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1069 contains the first component of a composition. */
1072 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string
*s
, bool force_p
)
1074 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1075 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1076 if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
1078 int box_line_width
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
1082 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1083 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
1084 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
,
1085 s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1086 s
->background_width
,
1087 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1088 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
1089 s
->background_filled_p
= true;
1091 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s
->font
) < s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
1092 || s
->font_not_found_p
1093 || s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1096 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1097 s
->background_width
,
1098 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1099 s
->background_filled_p
= true;
1105 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1108 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1112 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1113 of S to the right of that box line. */
1114 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1115 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1116 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1120 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1122 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1124 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; ++i
)
1126 struct glyph
*g
= s
->first_glyph
+ i
;
1127 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
,
1128 s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
, g
->pixel_width
- 1,
1130 x
+= g
->pixel_width
;
1135 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1136 int boff
= font
->baseline_offset
;
1139 if (font
->vertical_centering
)
1140 boff
= VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font
, s
->f
) - boff
;
1142 y
= s
->ybase
- boff
;
1144 || (s
->background_filled_p
&& s
->hl
!= DRAW_CURSOR
))
1145 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
, y
, false);
1147 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
, y
, true);
1148 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1149 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
+ 1, y
, false);
1153 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1156 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1159 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1161 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1162 of S to the right of that box line. */
1163 if (s
->face
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1164 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1165 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1169 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1170 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1171 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1172 this composition. */
1174 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1175 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1176 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1178 if (s
->cmp_from
== 0)
1179 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
,
1180 s
->width
- 1, s
->height
- 1);
1182 else if (! s
->first_glyph
->u
.cmp
.automatic
)
1186 for (i
= 0, j
= s
->cmp_from
; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++, j
++)
1187 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1188 space on the left or right. */
1189 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s
->cmp
, j
) != '\t')
1191 int xx
= x
+ s
->cmp
->offsets
[j
* 2];
1192 int yy
= y
- s
->cmp
->offsets
[j
* 2 + 1];
1194 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, j
+ 1, xx
, yy
, false);
1195 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1196 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, j
+ 1, xx
+ 1, yy
, false);
1201 Lisp_Object gstring
= composition_gstring_from_id (s
->cmp_id
);
1206 for (i
= j
= s
->cmp_from
; i
< s
->cmp_to
; i
++)
1208 glyph
= LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring
, i
);
1209 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph
)))
1210 width
+= LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph
);
1213 int xoff
, yoff
, wadjust
;
1217 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
, y
, false);
1218 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1219 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
+ 1, y
, false);
1222 xoff
= LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph
);
1223 yoff
= LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph
);
1224 wadjust
= LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph
);
1225 font
->driver
->draw (s
, i
, i
+ 1, x
+ xoff
, y
+ yoff
, false);
1226 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1227 font
->driver
->draw (s
, i
, i
+ 1, x
+ xoff
+ 1, y
+ yoff
,
1236 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
, y
, false);
1237 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1238 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
+ 1, y
, false);
1244 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1247 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1249 struct glyph
*glyph
= s
->first_glyph
;
1253 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1254 of S to the right of that box line. */
1255 if (s
->face
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1256 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1257 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1263 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++, glyph
++)
1265 char buf
[7], *str
= NULL
;
1266 int len
= glyph
->u
.glyphless
.len
;
1268 if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
== GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM
)
1271 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display
)
1272 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display
))
1276 = (! glyph
->u
.glyphless
.for_no_font
1277 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display
,
1278 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
)
1279 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display
)->extras
[0]);
1280 if (STRINGP (acronym
))
1281 str
= SSDATA (acronym
);
1284 else if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
== GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE
)
1286 sprintf (buf
, "%0*X",
1287 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
< 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1288 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
);
1294 int upper_len
= (len
+ 1) / 2;
1297 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1298 for (j
= 0; j
< len
; j
++)
1300 code
= s
->font
->driver
->encode_char (s
->font
, str
[j
]);
1301 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b
+ j
, code
>> 8, code
& 0xFF);
1303 s
->font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, upper_len
,
1304 x
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.upper_xoff
,
1305 s
->ybase
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.upper_yoff
,
1307 s
->font
->driver
->draw (s
, upper_len
, len
,
1308 x
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.lower_xoff
,
1309 s
->ybase
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.lower_yoff
,
1312 if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
!= GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE
)
1313 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
1314 x
, s
->ybase
- glyph
->ascent
,
1315 glyph
->pixel_width
- 1,
1316 glyph
->ascent
+ glyph
->descent
- 1);
1317 x
+= glyph
->pixel_width
;
1321 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1325 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1326 cannot be determined. */
1328 static struct frame
*
1329 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget
)
1331 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
1332 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
1335 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget
));
1337 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1338 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1339 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1340 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1341 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget
))
1342 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
1344 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1345 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1346 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
1350 && f
->output_data
.nothing
!= 1
1351 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
1352 && f
->output_data
.x
->widget
== widget
)
1358 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1359 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1360 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1361 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1362 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1363 Value is true if successful. */
1366 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget
, Display
*display
, Colormap cmap
,
1367 unsigned long *pixel
, double factor
, int delta
)
1369 struct frame
*f
= x_frame_of_widget (widget
);
1370 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, display
, cmap
, pixel
, factor
, delta
);
1373 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1376 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1377 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1379 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args
[] =
1381 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.screen
),
1383 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.colormap
),
1388 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1389 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1391 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1394 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1396 DPY is the display we are working on.
1398 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1399 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1400 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1401 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1403 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1404 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1406 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1407 we allocated the color or not.
1409 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1412 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display
*dpy
, XrmValue
*args
, Cardinal
*nargs
,
1413 XrmValue
*from
, XrmValue
*to
,
1414 XtPointer
*closure_ret
)
1424 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1425 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1427 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL
, NULL
);
1431 screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1432 cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1433 color_name
= (String
) from
->addr
;
1435 if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultBackground
) == 0)
1437 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1438 pixel
= WhitePixelOfScreen (screen
);
1440 else if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultForeground
) == 0)
1442 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1443 pixel
= BlackPixelOfScreen (screen
);
1445 else if (XParseColor (dpy
, cmap
, color_name
, &color
)
1446 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy
, cmap
, &color
))
1448 pixel
= color
.pixel
;
1449 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) True
;
1454 Cardinal nparams
= 1;
1456 params
[0] = color_name
;
1457 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1458 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1459 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1464 if (to
->addr
!= NULL
)
1466 if (to
->size
< sizeof (Pixel
))
1468 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1472 *(Pixel
*) to
->addr
= pixel
;
1476 cvt_string_to_pixel_value
= pixel
;
1477 to
->addr
= (XtPointer
) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1480 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1485 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1486 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1487 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1489 APP is the application context in which we work.
1491 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1492 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1493 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1495 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1498 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app
, XrmValuePtr to
, XtPointer closure
, XrmValuePtr args
,
1503 XtAppWarningMsg (app
, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1505 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1508 else if (closure
!= NULL
)
1510 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1511 Screen
*screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1512 Colormap cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1513 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen
), screen
, cmap
,
1514 (Pixel
*) to
->addr
, 1);
1519 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1522 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1523 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1524 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1525 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1527 static const XColor
*
1528 x_color_cells (Display
*dpy
, int *ncells
)
1530 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1532 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
== NULL
)
1534 Screen
*screen
= dpyinfo
->screen
;
1535 int ncolor_cells
= XDisplayCells (dpy
, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen
));
1538 dpyinfo
->color_cells
= xnmalloc (ncolor_cells
,
1539 sizeof *dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1540 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
= ncolor_cells
;
1542 for (i
= 0; i
< ncolor_cells
; ++i
)
1543 dpyinfo
->color_cells
[i
].pixel
= i
;
1545 XQueryColors (dpy
, dpyinfo
->cmap
,
1546 dpyinfo
->color_cells
, ncolor_cells
);
1549 *ncells
= dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
;
1550 return dpyinfo
->color_cells
;
1554 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1555 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1558 x_query_colors (struct frame
*f
, XColor
*colors
, int ncolors
)
1560 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
1562 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
)
1565 for (i
= 0; i
< ncolors
; ++i
)
1567 unsigned long pixel
= colors
[i
].pixel
;
1568 eassert (pixel
< dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
);
1569 eassert (dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
].pixel
== pixel
);
1570 colors
[i
] = dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
];
1574 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), colors
, ncolors
);
1578 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1579 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1582 x_query_color (struct frame
*f
, XColor
*color
)
1584 x_query_colors (f
, color
, 1);
1588 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1589 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1590 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1594 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display
*dpy
, Colormap cmap
, XColor
*color
)
1598 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
) != 0;
1601 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1602 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1603 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1604 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1606 int max_color_delta
= 255;
1607 int max_delta
= 3 * max_color_delta
;
1608 int nearest_delta
= max_delta
+ 1;
1610 const XColor
*cells
= x_color_cells (dpy
, &ncells
);
1612 for (nearest
= i
= 0; i
< ncells
; ++i
)
1614 int dred
= (color
->red
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].red
>> 8);
1615 int dgreen
= (color
->green
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].green
>> 8);
1616 int dblue
= (color
->blue
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].blue
>> 8);
1617 int delta
= dred
* dred
+ dgreen
* dgreen
+ dblue
* dblue
;
1619 if (delta
< nearest_delta
)
1622 nearest_delta
= delta
;
1626 color
->red
= cells
[nearest
].red
;
1627 color
->green
= cells
[nearest
].green
;
1628 color
->blue
= cells
[nearest
].blue
;
1629 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
) != 0;
1633 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1634 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1635 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1636 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1637 XColor
*cached_color
;
1639 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
1640 && (cached_color
= &dpyinfo
->color_cells
[color
->pixel
],
1641 (cached_color
->red
!= color
->red
1642 || cached_color
->blue
!= color
->blue
1643 || cached_color
->green
!= color
->green
)))
1645 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1646 dpyinfo
->color_cells
= NULL
;
1647 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
= 0;
1651 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1653 register_color (color
->pixel
);
1654 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1660 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1661 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1662 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1666 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame
*f
, Colormap cmap
, XColor
*color
)
1668 gamma_correct (f
, color
);
1669 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), cmap
, color
);
1673 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1674 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1675 get color reference counts right. */
1678 x_copy_color (struct frame
*f
, unsigned long pixel
)
1682 color
.pixel
= pixel
;
1684 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1685 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), &color
);
1687 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1688 register_color (pixel
);
1694 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1697 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1698 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1699 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1700 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1701 use an additional additive factor.
1703 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1704 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1705 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1708 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1709 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1710 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1711 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1712 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1713 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1716 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame
*f
, Display
*display
, Colormap cmap
,
1717 unsigned long *pixel
, double factor
, int delta
)
1723 /* Get RGB color values. */
1724 color
.pixel
= *pixel
;
1725 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1727 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1728 eassert (factor
>= 0);
1729 new.red
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.red
);
1730 new.green
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.green
);
1731 new.blue
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.blue
);
1733 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1734 bright
= (2 * color
.red
+ 3 * color
.green
+ color
.blue
) / 6;
1736 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1737 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1738 if (bright
< HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
)
1739 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1740 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1742 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1743 double dimness
= 1 - (double)bright
/ HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
;
1744 /* The additive adjustment. */
1745 int min_delta
= delta
* dimness
* factor
/ 2;
1749 new.red
= max (0, new.red
- min_delta
);
1750 new.green
= max (0, new.green
- min_delta
);
1751 new.blue
= max (0, new.blue
- min_delta
);
1755 new.red
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.red
);
1756 new.green
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.green
);
1757 new.blue
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.blue
);
1761 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1762 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1765 if (new.pixel
== *pixel
)
1767 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1768 delta to the RGB values. */
1769 x_free_colors (f
, &new.pixel
, 1);
1771 new.red
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.red
);
1772 new.green
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.green
);
1773 new.blue
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.blue
);
1774 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1785 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1786 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1787 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1788 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1789 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1790 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1793 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame
*f
, struct relief
*relief
, double factor
,
1794 int delta
, unsigned long default_pixel
)
1797 struct x_output
*di
= f
->output_data
.x
;
1798 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCLineWidth
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
1799 unsigned long pixel
;
1800 unsigned long background
= di
->relief_background
;
1801 Colormap cmap
= FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
);
1802 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
1803 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
1805 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
1806 xgcv
.line_width
= 1;
1808 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1809 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1810 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1811 if (relief
->gc
&& relief
->pixel
!= -1)
1813 x_free_colors (f
, &relief
->pixel
, 1);
1817 /* Allocate new color. */
1818 xgcv
.foreground
= default_pixel
;
1820 if (dpyinfo
->n_planes
!= 1
1821 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, dpy
, cmap
, &pixel
, factor
, delta
))
1822 xgcv
.foreground
= relief
->pixel
= pixel
;
1824 if (relief
->gc
== 0)
1826 xgcv
.stipple
= dpyinfo
->gray
;
1828 relief
->gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), mask
, &xgcv
);
1831 XChangeGC (dpy
, relief
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
1835 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1838 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1840 struct x_output
*di
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
;
1841 unsigned long color
;
1843 if (s
->face
->use_box_color_for_shadows_p
)
1844 color
= s
->face
->box_color
;
1845 else if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
1847 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0))
1848 color
= IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0);
1853 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1854 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
1855 color
= xgcv
.background
;
1858 if (di
->white_relief
.gc
== 0
1859 || color
!= di
->relief_background
)
1861 di
->relief_background
= color
;
1862 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->white_relief
, 1.2, 0x8000,
1863 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
1864 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->black_relief
, 0.6, 0x4000,
1865 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
1870 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1871 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1872 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P means draw a raised
1873 relief. LEFT_P means draw a relief on the left side of
1874 the rectangle. RIGHT_P means draw a relief on the right
1875 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1879 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame
*f
,
1880 int left_x
, int top_y
, int right_x
, int bottom_y
,
1881 int width
, bool raised_p
, bool top_p
, bool bot_p
,
1882 bool left_p
, bool right_p
,
1883 XRectangle
*clip_rect
)
1885 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
1886 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
1891 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
1893 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
1894 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
1896 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1897 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1898 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1905 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1906 left_x
+ left_p
, top_y
,
1907 right_x
+ !right_p
, top_y
);
1909 for (i
= 1; i
< width
; ++i
)
1910 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1911 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, top_y
+ i
,
1912 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, top_y
+ i
);
1919 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
, left_x
, top_y
+ 1, left_x
, bottom_y
);
1921 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, left_x
, top_y
, 1, 1, False
);
1922 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, left_x
, bottom_y
, 1, 1, False
);
1924 for (i
= (width
> 1 ? 1 : 0); i
< width
; ++i
)
1925 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1926 left_x
+ i
, top_y
+ (i
+ 1) * top_p
,
1927 left_x
+ i
, bottom_y
+ 1 - (i
+ 1) * bot_p
);
1930 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
1932 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
1934 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
1935 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
1939 /* Outermost top line. */
1941 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1942 left_x
+ left_p
, top_y
,
1943 right_x
+ !right_p
, top_y
);
1945 /* Outermost left line. */
1947 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
, left_x
, top_y
+ 1, left_x
, bottom_y
);
1953 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1954 left_x
+ left_p
, bottom_y
,
1955 right_x
+ !right_p
, bottom_y
);
1956 for (i
= 1; i
< width
; ++i
)
1957 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1958 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, bottom_y
- i
,
1959 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, bottom_y
- i
);
1965 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, right_x
, top_y
, 1, 1, False
);
1966 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, right_x
, bottom_y
, 1, 1, False
);
1967 for (i
= 0; i
< width
; ++i
)
1968 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1969 right_x
- i
, top_y
+ (i
+ 1) * top_p
,
1970 right_x
- i
, bottom_y
+ 1 - (i
+ 1) * bot_p
);
1973 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
1977 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
1978 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
1979 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P means draw a line on the
1980 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P means draw a line
1981 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
1982 rectangle to use when drawing. */
1985 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
,
1986 int left_x
, int top_y
, int right_x
, int bottom_y
, int width
,
1987 bool left_p
, bool right_p
, XRectangle
*clip_rect
)
1991 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
1992 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->box_color
);
1993 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
1996 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
1997 left_x
, top_y
, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2001 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2002 left_x
, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2005 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2006 left_x
, bottom_y
- width
+ 1, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2010 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2011 right_x
- width
+ 1, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2013 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2014 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2018 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2021 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2023 int width
, left_x
, right_x
, top_y
, bottom_y
, last_x
;
2024 bool raised_p
, left_p
, right_p
;
2025 struct glyph
*last_glyph
;
2026 XRectangle clip_rect
;
2028 last_x
= ((s
->row
->full_width_p
&& !s
->w
->pseudo_window_p
)
2029 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s
->w
)
2030 : window_box_right (s
->w
, s
->area
));
2032 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2033 last_glyph
= (s
->cmp
|| s
->img
2035 : s
->first_glyph
+ s
->nchars
- 1);
2037 width
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2038 raised_p
= s
->face
->box
== FACE_RAISED_BOX
;
2040 right_x
= (s
->row
->full_width_p
&& s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2042 : min (last_x
, s
->x
+ s
->background_width
) - 1);
2044 bottom_y
= top_y
+ s
->height
- 1;
2046 left_p
= (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2047 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2049 || s
->prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2050 right_p
= (last_glyph
->right_box_line_p
2051 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2053 || s
->next
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2055 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2057 if (s
->face
->box
== FACE_SIMPLE_BOX
)
2058 x_draw_box_rect (s
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
, width
,
2059 left_p
, right_p
, &clip_rect
);
2062 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2063 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
,
2064 width
, raised_p
, true, true, left_p
, right_p
,
2070 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2073 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2076 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2078 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2079 right of that line. */
2080 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2081 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2083 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2085 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2087 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2088 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2089 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2090 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2096 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2097 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2098 trust on the shape extension to be available
2099 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2101 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2104 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2106 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2107 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
;
2108 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
;
2109 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2110 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2112 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2115 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2116 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2117 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2118 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2119 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2120 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2124 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2126 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2129 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2130 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2131 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2132 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2133 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2134 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2136 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2137 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2138 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2139 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2140 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2141 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2142 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2144 int relief
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2145 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2146 x
- relief
, y
- relief
,
2147 s
->slice
.width
+ relief
*2 - 1,
2148 s
->slice
.height
+ relief
*2 - 1);
2153 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2154 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2155 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2159 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2162 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2165 bool raised_p
, top_p
, bot_p
, left_p
, right_p
;
2166 int extra_x
, extra_y
;
2169 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2171 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2172 right of that line. */
2173 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2174 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2176 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2178 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2180 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2181 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2182 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2183 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2185 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2186 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
)
2188 thick
= tool_bar_button_relief
>= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief
: DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF
;
2189 raised_p
= s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
;
2193 thick
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2194 raised_p
= s
->img
->relief
> 0;
2197 x1
= x
+ s
->slice
.width
- 1;
2198 y1
= y
+ s
->slice
.height
- 1;
2200 extra_x
= extra_y
= 0;
2201 if (s
->face
->id
== TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
)
2203 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin
)
2204 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin
))
2205 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin
)))
2207 extra_x
= XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin
));
2208 extra_y
= XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin
));
2210 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin
))
2211 extra_x
= extra_y
= XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin
);
2214 top_p
= bot_p
= left_p
= right_p
= false;
2216 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2217 x
-= thick
+ extra_x
, left_p
= true;
2218 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2219 y
-= thick
+ extra_y
, top_p
= true;
2220 if (s
->slice
.x
+ s
->slice
.width
== s
->img
->width
)
2221 x1
+= thick
+ extra_x
, right_p
= true;
2222 if (s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
== s
->img
->height
)
2223 y1
+= thick
+ extra_y
, bot_p
= true;
2225 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2226 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2227 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, x
, y
, x1
, y1
, thick
, raised_p
,
2228 top_p
, bot_p
, left_p
, right_p
, &r
);
2232 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2235 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string
*s
, Pixmap pixmap
)
2238 int y
= s
->ybase
- s
->y
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2240 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2241 right of that line. */
2242 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2243 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2245 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2247 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2249 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2250 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2251 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2252 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2258 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2259 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2260 trust on the shape extension to be available
2261 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2263 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2267 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2268 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
- s
->slice
.x
;
2269 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
- s
->slice
.y
;
2270 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2271 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2273 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2274 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2275 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2276 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2280 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2281 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2282 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2284 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2285 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2286 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2287 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2288 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2289 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2290 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2292 int r
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2293 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
- r
, y
- r
,
2294 s
->slice
.width
+ r
*2 - 1,
2295 s
->slice
.height
+ r
*2 - 1);
2300 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2301 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2302 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2306 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2307 give the rectangle to draw. */
2310 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
, int x
, int y
, int w
, int h
)
2314 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2315 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2316 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2317 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2320 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2324 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2327 s->x +-------------------------
2330 | +-------------------------
2333 | | +-------------------
2339 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2341 int box_line_hwidth
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2342 int box_line_vwidth
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
2344 Pixmap pixmap
= None
;
2347 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2348 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2349 if (s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
>= s
->img
->height
)
2350 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2352 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2353 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2355 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
2356 if (height
> s
->slice
.height
2360 || s
->img
->pixmap
== 0
2361 || s
->width
!= s
->background_width
)
2365 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2366 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2367 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2368 Screen
*screen
= FRAME_X_SCREEN (s
->f
);
2369 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen
);
2371 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2372 pixmap
= XCreatePixmap (s
->display
, s
->window
,
2373 s
->background_width
,
2376 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2378 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2380 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2383 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2384 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2385 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, - s
->x
, - s
->y
);
2386 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2387 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2388 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2389 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0);
2394 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
,
2396 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2397 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2398 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2399 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2406 int width
= s
->background_width
;
2408 if (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2411 x
+= box_line_hwidth
;
2412 width
-= box_line_hwidth
;
2415 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2416 y
+= box_line_vwidth
;
2418 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, y
, width
, height
);
2421 s
->background_filled_p
= true;
2424 /* Draw the foreground. */
2427 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s
, pixmap
);
2428 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2429 XCopyArea (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2430 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
, s
->x
, s
->y
);
2431 XFreePixmap (s
->display
, pixmap
);
2434 x_draw_image_foreground (s
);
2436 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2438 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2439 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
2440 x_draw_image_relief (s
);
2444 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2447 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2449 eassert (s
->first_glyph
->type
== STRETCH_GLYPH
);
2451 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
2452 && !x_stretch_cursor_p
)
2454 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2455 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2456 int width
, background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2459 if (!s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2461 int left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2465 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2471 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2473 int right_x
= window_box_right (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2475 if (x
+ background_width
> right_x
)
2476 background_width
-= x
- right_x
;
2477 x
+= background_width
;
2479 width
= min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s
->f
), background_width
);
2480 if (s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2484 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, width
, s
->height
);
2486 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2487 if (width
< background_width
)
2490 int w
= background_width
- width
, h
= s
->height
;
2494 if (!s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2498 if (s
->row
->mouse_face_p
2499 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s
->w
))
2501 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
2507 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2508 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
2510 if (s
->face
->stipple
)
2512 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2513 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2514 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2515 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillSolid
);
2520 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
2521 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2522 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2523 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2526 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, gc
, None
);
2529 else if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
2531 int background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2532 int x
= s
->x
, left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2534 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2535 except for header line and mode line. */
2536 if (x
< left_x
&& !s
->row
->mode_line_p
)
2538 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2541 if (background_width
> 0)
2542 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, background_width
, s
->height
);
2545 s
->background_filled_p
= true;
2549 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2555 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2560 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2562 int wave_height
= 3, wave_length
= 2;
2563 int dx
, dy
, x0
, y0
, width
, x1
, y1
, x2
, y2
, xmax
;
2565 XRectangle wave_clip
, string_clip
, final_clip
;
2568 dy
= wave_height
- 1;
2570 y0
= s
->ybase
- wave_height
+ 3;
2574 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2578 wave_clip
.width
= width
;
2579 wave_clip
.height
= wave_height
;
2580 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &string_clip
);
2582 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip
, &string_clip
, &final_clip
))
2585 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, &final_clip
, 1, Unsorted
);
2587 /* Draw the waves */
2589 x1
= x0
- (x0
% dx
);
2591 odd
= (x1
/ dx
) & 1;
2599 if (INT_MAX
- dx
< xmax
)
2604 XDrawLine (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x1
, y1
, x2
, y2
);
2606 x2
+= dx
, y2
= y0
+ odd
*dy
;
2610 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2611 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, s
->clip
, s
->num_clips
, Unsorted
);
2615 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2618 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2620 bool relief_drawn_p
= false;
2622 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2623 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2624 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2625 if (s
->next
&& s
->right_overhang
&& !s
->for_overlaps
)
2628 struct glyph_string
*next
;
2630 for (width
= 0, next
= s
->next
;
2631 next
&& width
< s
->right_overhang
;
2632 width
+= next
->width
, next
= next
->next
)
2633 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
!= IMAGE_GLYPH
)
2635 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next
);
2636 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next
);
2637 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
== STRETCH_GLYPH
)
2638 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next
);
2640 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next
, true);
2641 next
->num_clips
= 0;
2645 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2646 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s
);
2648 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2649 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2650 if (!s
->for_overlaps
2651 && s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2652 && (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
2653 || s
->first_glyph
->type
== COMPOSITE_GLYPH
))
2656 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2657 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, true);
2658 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2659 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2660 relief_drawn_p
= true;
2662 else if (!s
->clip_head
/* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2664 && ((s
->prev
&& s
->prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
&& s
->left_overhang
)
2665 || (s
->next
&& s
->next
->hl
!= s
->hl
&& s
->right_overhang
)))
2666 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2667 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2668 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2669 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, s
);
2671 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2673 switch (s
->first_glyph
->type
)
2676 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s
);
2680 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s
);
2684 if (s
->for_overlaps
)
2685 s
->background_filled_p
= true;
2687 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, false);
2688 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2691 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH
:
2692 if (s
->for_overlaps
|| (s
->cmp_from
> 0
2693 && ! s
->first_glyph
->u
.cmp
.automatic
))
2694 s
->background_filled_p
= true;
2696 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, true);
2697 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2700 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
:
2701 if (s
->for_overlaps
)
2702 s
->background_filled_p
= true;
2704 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, true);
2705 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2712 if (!s
->for_overlaps
)
2714 /* Draw underline. */
2715 if (s
->face
->underline_p
)
2717 if (s
->face
->underline_type
== FACE_UNDER_WAVE
)
2719 if (s
->face
->underline_defaulted_p
)
2720 x_draw_underwave (s
);
2724 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2725 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->underline_color
);
2726 x_draw_underwave (s
);
2727 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2730 else if (s
->face
->underline_type
== FACE_UNDER_LINE
)
2732 unsigned long thickness
, position
;
2735 if (s
->prev
&& s
->prev
->face
->underline_p
2736 && s
->prev
->face
->underline_type
== FACE_UNDER_LINE
)
2738 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2739 thickness
= s
->prev
->underline_thickness
;
2740 position
= s
->prev
->underline_position
;
2744 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2745 if (s
->font
&& s
->font
->underline_thickness
> 0)
2746 thickness
= s
->font
->underline_thickness
;
2749 if (x_underline_at_descent_line
)
2750 position
= (s
->height
- thickness
) - (s
->ybase
- s
->y
);
2753 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2754 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2755 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2756 specs, and its default is
2758 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2759 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2761 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2762 && s
->font
&& s
->font
->underline_position
>= 0)
2763 position
= s
->font
->underline_position
;
2765 position
= (s
->font
->descent
+ 1) / 2;
2767 position
= underline_minimum_offset
;
2769 position
= max (position
, underline_minimum_offset
);
2771 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2772 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2773 if (s
->y
+ s
->height
<= s
->ybase
+ position
)
2774 position
= (s
->height
- 1) - (s
->ybase
- s
->y
);
2775 if (s
->y
+ s
->height
< s
->ybase
+ position
+ thickness
)
2776 thickness
= (s
->y
+ s
->height
) - (s
->ybase
+ position
);
2777 s
->underline_thickness
= thickness
;
2778 s
->underline_position
= position
;
2779 y
= s
->ybase
+ position
;
2780 if (s
->face
->underline_defaulted_p
)
2781 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2782 s
->x
, y
, s
->width
, thickness
);
2786 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2787 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->underline_color
);
2788 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2789 s
->x
, y
, s
->width
, thickness
);
2790 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2794 /* Draw overline. */
2795 if (s
->face
->overline_p
)
2797 unsigned long dy
= 0, h
= 1;
2799 if (s
->face
->overline_color_defaulted_p
)
2800 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2805 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2806 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->overline_color
);
2807 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2809 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2813 /* Draw strike-through. */
2814 if (s
->face
->strike_through_p
)
2816 unsigned long h
= 1;
2817 unsigned long dy
= (s
->height
- h
) / 2;
2819 if (s
->face
->strike_through_color_defaulted_p
)
2820 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2825 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2826 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->strike_through_color
);
2827 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2829 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2833 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2834 if (!relief_drawn_p
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
)
2835 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2839 struct glyph_string
*prev
;
2841 for (prev
= s
->prev
; prev
; prev
= prev
->prev
)
2842 if (prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
2843 && prev
->x
+ prev
->width
+ prev
->right_overhang
> s
->x
)
2845 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2846 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2847 enum draw_glyphs_face save
= prev
->hl
;
2850 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev
);
2851 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, prev
);
2852 if (prev
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
2853 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev
);
2855 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev
);
2856 XSetClipMask (prev
->display
, prev
->gc
, None
);
2858 prev
->num_clips
= 0;
2864 struct glyph_string
*next
;
2866 for (next
= s
->next
; next
; next
= next
->next
)
2867 if (next
->hl
!= s
->hl
2868 && next
->x
- next
->left_overhang
< s
->x
+ s
->width
)
2870 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2871 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2872 enum draw_glyphs_face save
= next
->hl
;
2875 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next
);
2876 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, next
);
2877 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
2878 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next
);
2880 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next
);
2881 XSetClipMask (next
->display
, next
->gc
, None
);
2883 next
->num_clips
= 0;
2884 next
->clip_head
= s
->next
;
2889 /* Reset clipping. */
2890 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2894 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2897 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
, int shift_by
)
2899 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
2900 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
2901 x
, y
, width
, height
,
2905 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2909 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame
*f
, register int n
)
2915 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2916 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2919 x_clear_area (Display
*dpy
, Window window
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
)
2921 eassert (width
> 0 && height
> 0);
2922 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, x
, y
, width
, height
, False
);
2926 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2929 x_clear_frame (struct frame
*f
)
2931 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2933 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f
)));
2937 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
2939 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2940 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2941 x_scroll_bar_clear (f
);
2943 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2944 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2945 redisplay, do it here. */
2946 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
2947 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
2950 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
2955 /* RIF: Show hourglass cursor on frame F. */
2958 x_show_hourglass (struct frame
*f
)
2960 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
2964 struct x_output
*x
= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
);
2965 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
2968 if (FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
))
2971 x
->hourglass_p
= true;
2973 if (!x
->hourglass_window
)
2975 unsigned long mask
= CWCursor
;
2976 XSetWindowAttributes attrs
;
2978 Window parent
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
2980 Window parent
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
2982 attrs
.cursor
= x
->hourglass_cursor
;
2984 x
->hourglass_window
= XCreateWindow
2985 (dpy
, parent
, 0, 0, 32000, 32000, 0, 0,
2986 InputOnly
, CopyFromParent
, mask
, &attrs
);
2989 XMapRaised (dpy
, x
->hourglass_window
);
2995 /* RIF: Cancel hourglass cursor on frame F. */
2998 x_hide_hourglass (struct frame
*f
)
3000 struct x_output
*x
= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
);
3002 /* Watch out for newly created frames. */
3003 if (x
->hourglass_window
)
3005 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), x
->hourglass_window
);
3006 /* Sync here because XTread_socket looks at the
3007 hourglass_p flag that is reset to zero below. */
3008 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
3009 x
->hourglass_p
= false;
3013 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3016 XTflash (struct frame
*f
)
3022 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3023 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3024 GdkWindow
*window
= gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
3026 cairo_t
*cr
= gdk_cairo_create (window
);
3027 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr
, 1, 1, 1);
3028 cairo_set_operator (cr
, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE
);
3029 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3031 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3035 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3038 vals
.foreground
.pixel
= (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
)
3039 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
3040 vals
.function
= GDK_XOR
;
3041 gc
= gdk_gc_new_with_values (window
,
3042 &vals
, GDK_GC_FUNCTION
| GDK_GC_FOREGROUND
);
3043 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3044 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3045 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3046 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3049 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3050 pixels into background pixels. */
3054 values
.function
= GXxor
;
3055 values
.foreground
= (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
)
3056 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
3058 gc
= XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3059 GCFunction
| GCForeground
, &values
);
3063 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3064 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
3065 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3066 int flash_height
= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
3067 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3068 int flash_left
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
3069 int flash_right
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
3070 int width
= flash_right
- flash_left
;
3072 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3073 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3075 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3077 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3078 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
)),
3079 width
, flash_height
);
3080 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3082 (height
- flash_height
3083 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3084 width
, flash_height
);
3088 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3089 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3090 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3091 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3096 struct timespec delay
= make_timespec (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3097 struct timespec wakeup
= timespec_add (current_timespec (), delay
);
3099 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3101 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3103 struct timespec current
= current_timespec ();
3104 struct timespec timeout
;
3106 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3107 if (timespec_cmp (wakeup
, current
) <= 0)
3110 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3111 timeout
= make_timespec (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3113 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3114 pselect (0, NULL
, NULL
, NULL
, &timeout
, NULL
);
3118 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3119 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3121 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3123 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3124 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
)),
3125 width
, flash_height
);
3126 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3128 (height
- flash_height
3129 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3130 width
, flash_height
);
3133 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3134 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3135 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3136 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3142 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc
));
3144 #undef XFillRectangle
3146 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
);
3157 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (struct frame
*f
, bool invisible
)
3160 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->toggle_visible_pointer (f
, invisible
);
3165 /* Make audible bell. */
3168 XTring_bell (struct frame
*f
)
3170 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))
3178 XkbBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, 0, None
);
3180 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), 0);
3182 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3188 /***********************************************************************
3190 ***********************************************************************/
3192 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3193 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3196 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame
*f
, int vpos
, int n
)
3202 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3205 x_scroll_run (struct window
*w
, struct run
*run
)
3207 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
3208 int x
, y
, width
, height
, from_y
, to_y
, bottom_y
;
3210 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3211 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3213 window_box (w
, ANY_AREA
, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
);
3215 from_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->current_y
);
3216 to_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->desired_y
);
3217 bottom_y
= y
+ height
;
3221 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3222 line at the bottom. */
3223 if (from_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3224 height
= bottom_y
- from_y
;
3226 height
= run
->height
;
3230 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3232 if (to_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3233 height
= bottom_y
- to_y
;
3235 height
= run
->height
;
3240 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3243 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
3244 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3245 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
3255 /***********************************************************************
3257 ***********************************************************************/
3261 frame_highlight (struct frame
*f
)
3263 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3264 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3265 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3266 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3268 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3269 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3270 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3271 because of this (bug#9310). */
3272 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3273 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3274 f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
3275 x_uncatch_errors ();
3277 x_update_cursor (f
, true);
3278 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
3282 frame_unhighlight (struct frame
*f
)
3284 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3285 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3286 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3287 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3289 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3290 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3291 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3292 f
->output_data
.x
->border_tile
);
3293 x_uncatch_errors ();
3295 x_update_cursor (f
, true);
3296 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
3299 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3300 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3301 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3302 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3303 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3306 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
)
3308 struct frame
*old_focus
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3310 if (frame
!= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3312 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3313 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3314 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= frame
;
3316 if (old_focus
&& old_focus
->auto_lower
)
3317 x_lower_frame (old_focus
);
3319 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
&& dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
->auto_raise
)
3320 dpyinfo
->x_pending_autoraise_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3322 dpyinfo
->x_pending_autoraise_frame
= NULL
;
3325 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo
);
3328 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3329 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3330 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3333 x_focus_changed (int type
, int state
, struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
, struct input_event
*bufp
)
3335 if (type
== FocusIn
)
3337 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
!= frame
)
3339 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, frame
);
3340 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= frame
;
3342 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3343 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3344 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3345 bufp
->arg
= (((NILP (Vterminal_frame
)
3346 || ! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (Vterminal_frame
))
3347 || EQ (Fdaemonp (), Qt
))
3348 && CONSP (Vframe_list
)
3349 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
3351 bufp
->kind
= FOCUS_IN_EVENT
;
3352 XSETFRAME (bufp
->frame_or_window
, frame
);
3355 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
|= state
;
3358 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3359 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3362 else if (type
== FocusOut
)
3364 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
&= ~state
;
3366 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
== frame
)
3368 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
3369 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, 0);
3371 bufp
->kind
= FOCUS_OUT_EVENT
;
3372 XSETFRAME (bufp
->frame_or_window
, frame
);
3376 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3377 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3379 if (frame
->pointer_invisible
)
3380 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame
, false);
3384 /* Return the Emacs frame-object corresponding to an X window.
3385 It could be the frame's main window or an icon window. */
3387 static struct frame
*
3388 x_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, int wdesc
)
3390 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
3396 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3399 if (!FRAME_X_P (f
) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) != dpyinfo
)
3401 if (f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_window
== wdesc
)
3403 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3404 if ((f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
3405 && XtWindow (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
) == wdesc
)
3406 /* A tooltip frame? */
3407 || (!f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
3408 && FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == wdesc
)
3409 || f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
== wdesc
)
3411 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3413 if (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
)
3415 GtkWidget
*gwdesc
= xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo
->display
, wdesc
);
3416 struct x_output
*x
= f
->output_data
.x
;
3417 if (gwdesc
!= 0 && gwdesc
== x
->edit_widget
)
3420 #endif /* USE_GTK */
3421 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == wdesc
3422 || f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
== wdesc
)
3424 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3429 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
3431 /* Like x_window_to_frame but also compares the window with the widget's
3434 static struct frame
*
3435 x_any_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, int wdesc
)
3437 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
3438 struct frame
*f
, *found
= NULL
;
3444 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3449 if (FRAME_X_P (f
) && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
)
3451 /* This frame matches if the window is any of its widgets. */
3452 x
= f
->output_data
.x
;
3453 if (x
->hourglass_window
== wdesc
)
3458 GtkWidget
*gwdesc
= xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo
->display
, wdesc
);
3460 && gtk_widget_get_toplevel (gwdesc
) == x
->widget
)
3463 if (wdesc
== XtWindow (x
->widget
)
3464 || wdesc
== XtWindow (x
->column_widget
)
3465 || wdesc
== XtWindow (x
->edit_widget
))
3467 /* Match if the window is this frame's menubar. */
3468 else if (lw_window_is_in_menubar (wdesc
, x
->menubar_widget
))
3472 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == wdesc
)
3473 /* A tooltip frame. */
3481 /* Likewise, but consider only the menu bar widget. */
3483 static struct frame
*
3484 x_menubar_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
,
3485 const XEvent
*event
)
3487 Window wdesc
= event
->xany
.window
;
3488 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
3495 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3498 if (!FRAME_X_P (f
) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) != dpyinfo
)
3500 x
= f
->output_data
.x
;
3502 if (x
->menubar_widget
&& xg_event_is_for_menubar (f
, event
))
3505 /* Match if the window is this frame's menubar. */
3506 if (x
->menubar_widget
3507 && lw_window_is_in_menubar (wdesc
, x
->menubar_widget
))
3514 /* Return the frame whose principal (outermost) window is WDESC.
3515 If WDESC is some other (smaller) window, we return 0. */
3518 x_top_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, int wdesc
)
3520 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
3527 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3530 if (!FRAME_X_P (f
) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) != dpyinfo
)
3532 x
= f
->output_data
.x
;
3536 /* This frame matches if the window is its topmost widget. */
3538 GtkWidget
*gwdesc
= xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo
->display
, wdesc
);
3539 if (gwdesc
== x
->widget
)
3542 if (wdesc
== XtWindow (x
->widget
))
3546 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == wdesc
)
3547 /* Tooltip frame. */
3553 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT && !USE_GTK */
3555 #define x_any_window_to_frame(d, i) x_window_to_frame (d, i)
3556 #define x_top_window_to_frame(d, i) x_window_to_frame (d, i)
3558 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
3560 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3561 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3563 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3566 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
,
3567 const XEvent
*event
, struct input_event
*bufp
)
3572 switch (event
->type
)
3577 struct frame
*focus_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
;
3579 = focus_frame
? focus_frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
: 0;
3581 if (event
->xcrossing
.detail
!= NotifyInferior
3582 && event
->xcrossing
.focus
3583 && ! (focus_state
& FOCUS_EXPLICIT
))
3584 x_focus_changed ((event
->type
== EnterNotify
? FocusIn
: FocusOut
),
3586 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3592 x_focus_changed (event
->type
,
3593 (event
->xfocus
.detail
== NotifyPointer
?
3594 FOCUS_IMPLICIT
: FOCUS_EXPLICIT
),
3595 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3599 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
)
3601 enum xembed_message msg
= event
->xclient
.data
.l
[1];
3602 x_focus_changed ((msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_IN
? FocusIn
: FocusOut
),
3603 FOCUS_EXPLICIT
, dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3610 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3611 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3614 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3616 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
);
3620 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3621 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3622 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3624 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3625 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3626 the appropriate X display info. */
3629 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame
*frame
)
3631 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (frame
));
3635 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3637 struct frame
*old_highlight
= dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
;
3639 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3641 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
3642 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)))
3643 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
))
3644 : dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
);
3645 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
))
3647 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
, Qnil
);
3648 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3652 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
3654 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
!= old_highlight
)
3657 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight
);
3658 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
3659 frame_highlight (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
);
3665 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3667 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3669 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3671 int min_code
, max_code
;
3674 XModifierKeymap
*mods
;
3676 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= 0;
3677 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= 0;
3678 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3679 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
= 0;
3680 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
= 0;
3682 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo
->display
, &min_code
, &max_code
);
3684 syms
= XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo
->display
,
3685 min_code
, max_code
- min_code
+ 1,
3687 mods
= XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo
->display
);
3689 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3690 Alt keysyms are on. */
3692 int row
, col
; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3693 bool found_alt_or_meta
;
3695 for (row
= 3; row
< 8; row
++)
3697 found_alt_or_meta
= false;
3698 for (col
= 0; col
< mods
->max_keypermod
; col
++)
3700 KeyCode code
= mods
->modifiermap
[(row
* mods
->max_keypermod
) + col
];
3702 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3706 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3710 for (code_col
= 0; code_col
< syms_per_code
; code_col
++)
3712 int sym
= syms
[((code
- min_code
) * syms_per_code
) + code_col
];
3718 found_alt_or_meta
= true;
3719 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3724 found_alt_or_meta
= true;
3725 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3730 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3731 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3732 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3733 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3738 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3739 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3740 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3741 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3745 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3746 if (!found_alt_or_meta
&& ((1 << row
) == LockMask
))
3747 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= LockMask
;
3748 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3749 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3758 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3759 if (! dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3761 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
;
3762 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3765 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3766 make them just meta, not alt. */
3767 if (dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3769 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
&= ~dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
;
3773 XFreeModifiermap (mods
);
3776 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3780 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, int state
)
3782 int mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3783 int mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3784 int mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3785 int mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3788 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3789 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_alt
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3790 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3791 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_meta
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3792 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3793 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_hyper
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3794 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3795 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_super
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3797 return ( ((state
& (ShiftMask
| dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
)) ? shift_modifier
: 0)
3798 | ((state
& ControlMask
) ? ctrl_modifier
: 0)
3799 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
) ? mod_meta
: 0)
3800 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
) ? mod_alt
: 0)
3801 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
) ? mod_super
: 0)
3802 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
) ? mod_hyper
: 0));
3806 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, EMACS_INT state
)
3808 EMACS_INT mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3809 EMACS_INT mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3810 EMACS_INT mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3811 EMACS_INT mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3815 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3816 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_alt
= XINT (tem
);
3817 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3818 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_meta
= XINT (tem
);
3819 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3820 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_hyper
= XINT (tem
);
3821 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3822 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_super
= XINT (tem
);
3825 return ( ((state
& mod_alt
) ? dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
: 0)
3826 | ((state
& mod_super
) ? dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
: 0)
3827 | ((state
& mod_hyper
) ? dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
: 0)
3828 | ((state
& shift_modifier
) ? ShiftMask
: 0)
3829 | ((state
& ctrl_modifier
) ? ControlMask
: 0)
3830 | ((state
& mod_meta
) ? dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
: 0));
3833 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3836 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym
)
3841 value
= XKeysymToString (keysym
);
3847 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah.
3849 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
3850 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
3851 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
3852 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
3854 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
3856 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
3857 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
3858 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
3859 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
3860 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
3861 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
3862 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
3863 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
3864 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
3867 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3869 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3873 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event
*result
,
3874 const XButtonEvent
*event
,
3877 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3879 result
->kind
= MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT
;
3880 result
->code
= event
->button
- Button1
;
3881 result
->timestamp
= event
->time
;
3882 result
->modifiers
= (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
3884 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
3888 XSETINT (result
->x
, event
->x
);
3889 XSETINT (result
->y
, event
->y
);
3890 XSETFRAME (result
->frame_or_window
, f
);
3895 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3896 The input handler calls this.
3898 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3899 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3900 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3901 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3904 note_mouse_movement (struct frame
*frame
, const XMotionEvent
*event
)
3907 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
3909 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame
))
3912 dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (frame
);
3913 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->time
;
3914 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_motion_frame
= frame
;
3915 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_motion_x
= event
->x
;
3916 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_motion_y
= event
->y
;
3918 if (event
->window
!= FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame
))
3920 frame
->mouse_moved
= true;
3921 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= NULL
;
3922 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, -1, -1);
3923 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
= NULL
;
3928 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3929 r
= &dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph
;
3930 if (frame
!= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
3931 || event
->x
< r
->x
|| event
->x
>= r
->x
+ r
->width
3932 || event
->y
< r
->y
|| event
->y
>= r
->y
+ r
->height
)
3934 frame
->mouse_moved
= true;
3935 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= NULL
;
3936 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
);
3937 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3938 remember_mouse_glyph (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
, r
);
3939 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
= frame
;
3946 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3947 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3949 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3950 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3951 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3952 position on the scroll bar.
3954 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3955 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3958 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3959 was at this position.
3961 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3963 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3967 XTmouse_position (struct frame
**fp
, int insist
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
,
3968 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
, Lisp_Object
*y
,
3972 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
);
3976 if (dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
&& insist
== 0)
3978 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
;
3980 if (bar
->horizontal
)
3981 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp
, bar_window
, part
, x
, y
, timestamp
);
3983 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp
, bar_window
, part
, x
, y
, timestamp
);
3990 Window dummy_window
;
3993 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
3995 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3996 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3997 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
3998 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
))
3999 XFRAME (frame
)->mouse_moved
= false;
4001 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= NULL
;
4003 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
4004 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
4005 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)),
4007 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
4010 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
4011 a different screen. */
4014 /* The position on that root window. */
4017 /* More trash we can't trust. */
4020 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
4022 (unsigned int *) &dummy
);
4024 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
4025 containing the pointer. */
4029 int parent_x
= 0, parent_y
= 0;
4033 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
4034 structure is changing at the same time this function
4035 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
4037 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
));
4039 if (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo
))
4041 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
4042 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
4043 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
4049 FRAME_X_WINDOW (dpyinfo
->last_mouse_frame
),
4051 /* From-position, to-position. */
4052 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
4056 f1
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_frame
;
4062 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
4064 /* From-window, to-window. */
4067 /* From-position, to-position. */
4068 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
4073 if (child
== None
|| child
== win
)
4076 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4077 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
4078 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
4079 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
4080 if (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, win
))
4088 /* Now we know that:
4089 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4090 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4091 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4092 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4093 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4094 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4095 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4096 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4097 never use them in that case.) */
4100 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4101 want the edit window. */
4102 f1
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, win
);
4104 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4105 f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, win
);
4108 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4109 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4112 && f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
4113 && win
== XtWindow (f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
))
4115 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4118 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)))
4121 x_uncatch_errors ();
4123 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4126 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
4128 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
), win
, 2);
4132 f1
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
4138 if (f1
== 0 && insist
> 0)
4139 f1
= SELECTED_FRAME ();
4143 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4144 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4145 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4146 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4147 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4148 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4149 the frame are divided into. */
4151 /* FIXME: what if F1 is not an X frame? */
4152 dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f1
);
4153 remember_mouse_glyph (f1
, win_x
, win_y
, &dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph
);
4154 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
= f1
;
4157 *part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4159 XSETINT (*x
, win_x
);
4160 XSETINT (*y
, win_y
);
4161 *timestamp
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_movement_time
;
4171 /***********************************************************************
4173 ***********************************************************************/
4175 /* Scroll bar support. */
4177 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4179 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4182 static struct scroll_bar
*
4183 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display
*display
, Window window_id
, int type
)
4185 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
4187 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4188 window_id
= (Window
) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display
, window_id
);
4189 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4191 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
4193 Lisp_Object bar
, condemned
;
4195 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
4198 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4200 condemned
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
4201 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
4202 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4203 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4204 ! NILP (bar
) || (bar
= condemned
,
4207 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
4208 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
== window_id
4209 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == display
4211 || (type
== 1 && XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->horizontal
)
4212 || (type
== 0 && !XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->horizontal
)))
4213 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
4220 #if defined USE_LUCID
4222 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4223 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4226 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window
)
4228 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
4230 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
4231 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
4233 Widget menu_bar
= XFRAME (frame
)->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
;
4235 if (menu_bar
&& xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar
, window
))
4241 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4244 /************************************************************************
4246 ************************************************************************/
4248 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4250 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object
, enum scroll_bar_part
,
4253 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4254 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4256 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled
;
4258 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4259 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4262 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4264 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id
;
4265 static XtActionHookId horizontal_action_hook_id
;
4267 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll
;
4269 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4270 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4271 to avoid jerkiness. */
4273 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top
;
4275 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4276 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4277 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4278 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4281 xt_action_hook (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, String action_name
,
4282 XEvent
*event
, String
*params
, Cardinal
*num_params
)
4285 const char *end_action
;
4288 scroll_bar_p
= XmIsScrollBar (widget
);
4289 end_action
= "Release";
4290 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4291 scroll_bar_p
= XtIsSubclass (widget
, scrollbarWidgetClass
);
4292 end_action
= "EndScroll";
4293 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4296 && strcmp (action_name
, end_action
) == 0
4297 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4300 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
4302 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4303 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0, false);
4304 w
= XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled
);
4305 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
4307 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
4310 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4311 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w
);
4313 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4314 #if defined (USE_LUCID)
4315 bar
->last_seen_part
= scroll_bar_nowhere
;
4317 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4318 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= false;
4324 xt_horizontal_action_hook (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, String action_name
,
4325 XEvent
*event
, String
*params
, Cardinal
*num_params
)
4328 const char *end_action
;
4331 scroll_bar_p
= XmIsScrollBar (widget
);
4332 end_action
= "Release";
4333 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4334 scroll_bar_p
= XtIsSubclass (widget
, scrollbarWidgetClass
);
4335 end_action
= "EndScroll";
4336 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4339 && strcmp (action_name
, end_action
) == 0
4340 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4343 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
4345 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4346 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0, true);
4347 w
= XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled
);
4348 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
);
4350 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
4353 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4354 set_horizontal_scroll_bar (w
);
4356 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4357 #if defined (USE_LUCID)
4358 bar
->last_seen_part
= scroll_bar_nowhere
;
4360 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4361 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= false;
4364 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4366 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4367 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4368 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4369 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4372 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window
, enum scroll_bar_part part
,
4373 int portion
, int whole
, bool horizontal
)
4376 XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= &event
.xclient
;
4377 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (window
);
4378 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4379 intptr_t iw
= (intptr_t) w
;
4380 enum { BITS_PER_INTPTR
= CHAR_BIT
* sizeof iw
};
4381 verify (BITS_PER_INTPTR
<= 64);
4382 int sign_shift
= BITS_PER_INTPTR
- 32;
4386 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4387 ev
->type
= ClientMessage
;
4388 ev
->message_type
= (horizontal
4389 ? FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar
4390 : FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_Scrollbar
);
4391 ev
->display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
4392 ev
->window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
4395 /* A 32-bit X client on a 64-bit X server can pass a window pointer
4396 as-is. A 64-bit client on a 32-bit X server is in trouble
4397 because a pointer does not fit and would be truncated while
4398 passing through the server. So use two slots and hope that X12
4399 will resolve such issues someday. */
4400 ev
->data
.l
[0] = iw
>> 31 >> 1;
4401 ev
->data
.l
[1] = sign_shift
<= 0 ? iw
: iw
<< sign_shift
>> sign_shift
;
4402 ev
->data
.l
[2] = part
;
4403 ev
->data
.l
[3] = portion
;
4404 ev
->data
.l
[4] = whole
;
4406 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4407 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4408 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= true;
4409 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4412 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4413 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4414 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4415 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), False
, 0, &event
);
4420 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4424 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (const XEvent
*event
,
4425 struct input_event
*ievent
)
4427 const XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= &event
->xclient
;
4431 /* See the comment in the function above. */
4432 intptr_t iw0
= ev
->data
.l
[0];
4433 intptr_t iw1
= ev
->data
.l
[1];
4434 intptr_t iw
= (iw0
<< 31 << 1) + (iw1
& 0xffffffffu
);
4435 w
= (struct window
*) iw
;
4437 XSETWINDOW (window
, w
);
4439 ievent
->kind
= SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
4440 ievent
->frame_or_window
= window
;
4443 ievent
->timestamp
= CurrentTime
;
4446 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w
->frame
)));
4449 ievent
->part
= ev
->data
.l
[2];
4450 ievent
->x
= make_number (ev
->data
.l
[3]);
4451 ievent
->y
= make_number (ev
->data
.l
[4]);
4452 ievent
->modifiers
= 0;
4455 /* Transform a horizontal scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs
4456 input event in *IEVENT. */
4459 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_to_input_event (const XEvent
*event
,
4460 struct input_event
*ievent
)
4462 const XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= &event
->xclient
;
4466 /* See the comment in the function above. */
4467 intptr_t iw0
= ev
->data
.l
[0];
4468 intptr_t iw1
= ev
->data
.l
[1];
4469 intptr_t iw
= (iw0
<< 31 << 1) + (iw1
& 0xffffffffu
);
4470 w
= (struct window
*) iw
;
4472 XSETWINDOW (window
, w
);
4474 ievent
->kind
= HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
4475 ievent
->frame_or_window
= window
;
4478 ievent
->timestamp
= CurrentTime
;
4481 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w
->frame
)));
4484 ievent
->part
= ev
->data
.l
[2];
4485 ievent
->x
= make_number (ev
->data
.l
[3]);
4486 ievent
->y
= make_number (ev
->data
.l
[4]);
4487 ievent
->modifiers
= 0;
4493 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4495 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4497 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4498 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4499 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4502 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4504 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= client_data
;
4505 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct
*cs
= call_data
;
4506 enum scroll_bar_part part
= scroll_bar_nowhere
;
4507 bool horizontal
= bar
->horizontal
;
4508 int whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4512 case XmCR_DECREMENT
:
4514 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_left_arrow
: scroll_bar_up_arrow
;
4517 case XmCR_INCREMENT
:
4519 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_right_arrow
: scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4522 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT
:
4524 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_before_handle
: scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4527 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT
:
4529 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_after_handle
: scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4534 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_to_leftmost
: scroll_bar_to_top
;
4537 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM
:
4539 part
= horizontal
? scroll_bar_to_rightmost
: scroll_bar_to_bottom
;
4547 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XmNsliderSize
, &slider_size
, NULL
);
4552 portion
= bar
->whole
* ((float)cs
->value
/ XM_SB_MAX
);
4553 whole
= bar
->whole
* ((float)(XM_SB_MAX
- slider_size
) / XM_SB_MAX
);
4554 portion
= min (portion
, whole
);
4555 part
= scroll_bar_horizontal_handle
;
4559 whole
= XM_SB_MAX
- slider_size
;
4560 portion
= min (cs
->value
, whole
);
4561 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4564 bar
->dragging
= cs
->value
;
4568 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED
:
4572 if (part
!= scroll_bar_nowhere
)
4574 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4575 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
,
4580 #elif defined USE_GTK
4582 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4583 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4586 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange
*range
,
4587 GtkScrollType scroll
,
4591 int whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4592 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= user_data
;
4593 enum scroll_bar_part part
= scroll_bar_nowhere
;
4594 GtkAdjustment
*adj
= GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range
));
4595 struct frame
*f
= g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range
), XG_FRAME_DATA
);
4597 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar
) return FALSE
;
4601 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP
:
4602 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4603 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->grabbed
!= 0
4604 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->grabbed
< (1 << 4))
4606 if (bar
->horizontal
)
4608 part
= scroll_bar_horizontal_handle
;
4609 whole
= (int)(gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj
) -
4610 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj
));
4611 portion
= min ((int)value
, whole
);
4612 bar
->dragging
= portion
;
4616 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4617 whole
= gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj
) -
4618 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj
);
4619 portion
= min ((int)value
, whole
);
4620 bar
->dragging
= portion
;
4624 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD
:
4625 part
= (bar
->horizontal
4626 ? scroll_bar_left_arrow
: scroll_bar_up_arrow
);
4629 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD
:
4630 part
= (bar
->horizontal
4631 ? scroll_bar_right_arrow
: scroll_bar_down_arrow
);
4634 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD
:
4635 part
= (bar
->horizontal
4636 ? scroll_bar_before_handle
: scroll_bar_above_handle
);
4639 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD
:
4640 part
= (bar
->horizontal
4641 ? scroll_bar_after_handle
: scroll_bar_below_handle
);
4646 if (part
!= scroll_bar_nowhere
)
4648 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4649 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
,
4656 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to -1 when dragging is done. */
4659 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget
*widget
,
4660 GdkEventButton
*event
,
4663 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= user_data
;
4665 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4667 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4668 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0, bar
->horizontal
);
4669 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4676 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4678 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4679 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4680 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4684 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4686 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= client_data
;
4687 float *top_addr
= call_data
;
4688 float top
= *top_addr
;
4690 int whole
, portion
, height
, width
;
4691 enum scroll_bar_part part
;
4692 bool horizontal
= bar
->horizontal
;
4697 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4699 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNshown
, &shown
, XtNwidth
, &width
, NULL
);
4704 whole
= bar
->whole
- (shown
* bar
->whole
);
4705 portion
= min (top
* bar
->whole
, whole
);
4713 part
= scroll_bar_horizontal_handle
;
4717 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4719 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNshown
, &shown
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4723 portion
= shown
< 1 ? top
* whole
: 0;
4725 if (shown
< 1 && (eabs (top
+ shown
- 1) < 1.0f
/ height
))
4726 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4727 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4728 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4729 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4731 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4733 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4736 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4737 bar
->dragging
= portion
;
4738 bar
->last_seen_part
= part
;
4739 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
, bar
->horizontal
);
4743 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4744 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4745 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4746 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4747 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4748 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4749 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4752 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4754 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= client_data
;
4755 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4756 int position
= (intptr_t) call_data
;
4757 Dimension height
, width
;
4758 enum scroll_bar_part part
;
4760 if (bar
->horizontal
)
4762 /* Get the width of the scroll bar. */
4764 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNwidth
, &width
, NULL
);
4767 if (eabs (position
) >= width
)
4768 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_before_handle
: scroll_bar_after_handle
;
4770 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4771 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4772 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
&& eabs (position
) <= max (5, width
/ 20))
4773 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_left_arrow
: scroll_bar_right_arrow
;
4775 part
= scroll_bar_move_ratio
;
4777 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4779 bar
->last_seen_part
= part
;
4780 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, position
, width
,
4786 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4788 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4791 if (eabs (position
) >= height
)
4792 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle
: scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4794 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4795 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4796 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
&& eabs (position
) <= max (5, height
/ 20))
4797 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow
: scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4799 part
= scroll_bar_move_ratio
;
4801 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4803 bar
->last_seen_part
= part
;
4804 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, position
, height
,
4809 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4811 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4812 #define SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME "horizontalScrollBar"
4814 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4815 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4819 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4821 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4824 xg_create_scroll_bar (f
, bar
, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback
),
4825 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback
),
4831 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4833 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME
;
4836 xg_create_horizontal_scroll_bar (f
, bar
, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback
),
4837 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback
),
4842 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4845 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4851 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4852 unsigned long pixel
;
4857 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4858 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4859 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNminimum
, 0); ++ac
;
4860 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNmaximum
, XM_SB_MAX
); ++ac
;
4861 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNorientation
, XmVERTICAL
); ++ac
;
4862 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNprocessingDirection
, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM
), ++ac
;
4863 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNincrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4864 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNpageIncrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4866 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4869 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNforeground
, pixel
);
4873 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4876 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNbackground
, pixel
);
4880 widget
= XmCreateScrollBar (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
,
4881 (char *) scroll_bar_name
, av
, ac
);
4883 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4884 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4886 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdragCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4888 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNincrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4890 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageDecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4892 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageIncrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4894 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoBottomCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4896 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoTopCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4899 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4900 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
4902 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4903 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4904 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget
), XtWindow (widget
),
4905 f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
);
4907 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4909 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4910 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4911 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4912 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4913 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4914 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNorientation
, XtorientVertical
); ++ac
;
4915 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4916 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4918 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4921 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNforeground
, pixel
);
4925 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4928 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbackground
, pixel
);
4932 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4934 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4935 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4937 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4940 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
4941 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4942 &pixel
, 1.2, 0x8000))
4944 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4947 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4949 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4952 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
4953 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4954 &pixel
, 0.6, 0x4000))
4956 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4960 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4961 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4962 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1
4963 || f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4964 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4965 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4966 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4969 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
,
4970 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
)) < 16);
4974 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4975 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4976 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4978 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4980 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
, False
);
4983 /* Specify the colors. */
4984 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
;
4987 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNtopShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4990 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
;
4993 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbottomShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4999 widget
= XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name
, scrollbarWidgetClass
,
5000 f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
, av
, ac
);
5003 char const *initial
= "";
5004 char const *val
= initial
;
5005 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNscrollVCursor
, (XtPointer
) &val
,
5006 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
5007 XtNarrowScrollbars
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll
,
5009 XtNpickTop
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_pick_top
, NULL
);
5010 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
|| val
== initial
)
5011 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
5012 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= True
;
5013 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
5014 XtVaSetValues (widget
, XtNcursorName
, "top_left_arrow", NULL
);
5018 /* Define callbacks. */
5019 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNjumpProc
, xaw_jump_callback
, (XtPointer
) bar
);
5020 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNscrollProc
, xaw_scroll_callback
,
5023 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5024 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
5026 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5028 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
5029 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
5030 if (action_hook_id
== 0)
5031 action_hook_id
= XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con
, xt_action_hook
, 0);
5033 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
5034 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar
, widget
);
5035 xwindow
= XtWindow (widget
);
5036 bar
->x_window
= xwindow
;
5038 bar
->horizontal
= false;
5044 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
5050 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME
;
5051 unsigned long pixel
;
5056 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
5057 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
5058 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNminimum
, 0); ++ac
;
5059 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNmaximum
, XM_SB_MAX
); ++ac
;
5060 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNorientation
, XmHORIZONTAL
); ++ac
;
5061 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNprocessingDirection
, XmMAX_ON_RIGHT
), ++ac
;
5062 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNincrement
, 1); ++ac
;
5063 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNpageIncrement
, 1); ++ac
;
5065 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
5068 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNforeground
, pixel
);
5072 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
5075 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNbackground
, pixel
);
5079 widget
= XmCreateScrollBar (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
,
5080 (char *) scroll_bar_name
, av
, ac
);
5082 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
5083 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5085 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdragCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5087 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNincrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5089 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageDecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5091 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageIncrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5093 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoBottomCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5095 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoTopCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
5098 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5099 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
5101 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
5102 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
5103 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget
), XtWindow (widget
),
5104 f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
);
5106 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5108 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
5109 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
5110 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
5111 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
5112 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
5113 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNorientation
, XtorientHorizontal
); ++ac
;
5114 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
5115 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
5117 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
5120 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNforeground
, pixel
);
5124 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
5127 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbackground
, pixel
);
5131 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
5133 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
5134 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1)
5136 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
5139 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5140 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
5141 &pixel
, 1.2, 0x8000))
5143 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
5146 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
5148 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
5151 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5152 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
5153 &pixel
, 0.6, 0x4000))
5155 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
5159 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
5160 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
5161 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1
5162 || f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
5163 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
5164 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
5165 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
5168 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
,
5169 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
)) < 16);
5173 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
5174 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
5175 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
5177 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
5179 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
, False
);
5182 /* Specify the colors. */
5183 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
;
5186 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNtopShadowPixel
, pixel
);
5189 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
;
5192 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbottomShadowPixel
, pixel
);
5198 widget
= XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name
, scrollbarWidgetClass
,
5199 f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
, av
, ac
);
5202 char const *initial
= "";
5203 char const *val
= initial
;
5204 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNscrollVCursor
, (XtPointer
) &val
,
5205 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
5206 XtNarrowScrollbars
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll
,
5208 XtNpickTop
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_pick_top
, NULL
);
5209 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
|| val
== initial
)
5210 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
5211 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= True
;
5212 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
5213 XtVaSetValues (widget
, XtNcursorName
, "top_left_arrow", NULL
);
5217 /* Define callbacks. */
5218 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNjumpProc
, xaw_jump_callback
, (XtPointer
) bar
);
5219 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNscrollProc
, xaw_scroll_callback
,
5222 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5223 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
5225 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5227 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
5228 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
5229 if (horizontal_action_hook_id
== 0)
5230 horizontal_action_hook_id
5231 = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con
, xt_horizontal_action_hook
, 0);
5233 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
5234 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar
, widget
);
5235 xwindow
= XtWindow (widget
);
5236 bar
->x_window
= xwindow
;
5238 bar
->horizontal
= true;
5242 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5245 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
5246 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
5250 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
, int whole
)
5252 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5256 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
, int whole
)
5258 xg_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5261 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5263 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
,
5266 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5267 Widget widget
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
5274 if (scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p
)
5276 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
5277 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
5278 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
5279 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
5280 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
5281 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
5282 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
5283 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
5284 its size, the update will often happen too late.
5285 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
5286 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
5287 portion
= WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)) * 30;
5288 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
5289 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
5297 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
5298 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
5301 if (bar
->dragging
== -1)
5305 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
5306 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
5308 size
= clip_to_bounds (1, shown
* XM_SB_MAX
, XM_SB_MAX
);
5310 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
5311 value
= top
* XM_SB_MAX
;
5312 value
= min (value
, XM_SB_MAX
- size
);
5314 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget
, value
, size
, 0, 0, False
);
5316 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5322 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
5323 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
5327 float old_top
, old_shown
;
5329 XtVaGetValues (widget
,
5330 XtNtopOfThumb
, &old_top
,
5331 XtNshown
, &old_shown
,
5335 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
5336 if (bar
->dragging
== -1 || bar
->last_seen_part
== scroll_bar_down_arrow
)
5337 top
= max (0, min (1, top
));
5340 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5341 /* With Xaw, 'top' values too closer to 1.0 may
5342 cause the thumb to disappear. Fix that. */
5343 top
= min (top
, 0.99f
);
5345 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
5346 shown
= max (0, min (1 - top
- (2.0f
/ height
), shown
));
5347 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5348 /* Likewise with too small 'shown'. */
5349 shown
= max (shown
, 0.01f
);
5352 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to
5353 work, check that 'NARROWPROTO' is defined in src/config.h.
5354 If this is not so, most likely you need to fix configure. */
5355 if (top
!= old_top
|| shown
!= old_shown
)
5357 if (bar
->dragging
== -1)
5358 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
5361 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
5362 if (!xaw3d_pick_top
)
5363 shown
= min (shown
, old_shown
);
5365 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
5369 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5375 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
,
5378 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5379 Widget widget
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
5386 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
5387 top
= (float) position
/ (whole
- portion
);
5389 int size
= clip_to_bounds (1, shown
* XM_SB_MAX
, XM_SB_MAX
);
5390 int value
= clip_to_bounds (0, top
* (XM_SB_MAX
- size
), XM_SB_MAX
- size
);
5392 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget
, value
, size
, 0, 0, False
);
5394 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5400 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
5401 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
5405 float old_top
, old_shown
;
5407 XtVaGetValues (widget
,
5408 XtNtopOfThumb
, &old_top
,
5409 XtNshown
, &old_shown
,
5414 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
5415 if (bar
->dragging
== -1 || bar
->last_seen_part
== scroll_bar_down_arrow
)
5416 top
= max (0, min (1, top
));
5419 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5420 /* With Xaw, 'top' values too closer to 1.0 may
5421 cause the thumb to disappear. Fix that. */
5422 top
= min (top
, 0.99f
);
5424 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
5425 shown
= max (0, min (1 - top
- (2.0f
/ height
), shown
));
5426 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5427 /* Likewise with too small 'shown'. */
5428 shown
= max (shown
, 0.01f
);
5432 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to
5433 work, check that 'NARROWPROTO' is defined in src/config.h.
5434 If this is not so, most likely you need to fix configure. */
5435 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
5437 if (top
!= old_top
|| shown
!= old_shown
)
5439 if (bar
->dragging
== -1)
5440 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
5443 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
5444 if (!xaw3d_pick_top
)
5445 shown
= min (shown
, old_shown
);
5447 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
5452 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5456 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5458 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5462 /************************************************************************
5463 Scroll bars, general
5464 ************************************************************************/
5466 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
5467 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
5468 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
5471 static struct scroll_bar
*
5472 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window
*w
, int top
, int left
,
5473 int width
, int height
, bool horizontal
)
5475 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
5476 struct scroll_bar
*bar
5477 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar
, x_window
, PVEC_OTHER
);
5482 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5484 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (f
, bar
);
5486 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f
, bar
);
5487 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5489 XSetWindowAttributes a
;
5493 a
.background_pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
5494 if (a
.background_pixel
== -1)
5495 a
.background_pixel
= FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
);
5497 a
.event_mask
= (ButtonPressMask
| ButtonReleaseMask
5498 | ButtonMotionMask
| PointerMotionHintMask
5500 a
.cursor
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
;
5502 mask
= (CWBackPixel
| CWEventMask
| CWCursor
);
5504 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
5505 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
5506 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
5507 if (width
> 0 && window_box_height (w
) > 0)
5508 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5509 left
, top
, width
, window_box_height (w
));
5511 window
= XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5512 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
5513 left
, top
, width
, height
,
5514 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
5521 bar
->x_window
= window
;
5523 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5525 XSETWINDOW (bar
->window
, w
);
5529 bar
->height
= height
;
5533 bar
->horizontal
= horizontal
;
5534 #if defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS) && defined (USE_LUCID)
5535 bar
->last_seen_part
= scroll_bar_nowhere
;
5538 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5539 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
5541 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
5542 fset_scroll_bars (f
, barobj
);
5543 if (!NILP (bar
->next
))
5544 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
5546 /* Map the window/widget. */
5547 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5551 xg_update_horizontal_scrollbar_pos (f
, bar
->x_window
, top
,
5552 left
, width
, max (height
, 1));
5554 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
, bar
->x_window
, top
,
5555 left
, width
, max (height
, 1));
5556 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5557 Widget scroll_bar
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
5558 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar
, left
, top
, width
, max (height
, 1), 0);
5559 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar
);
5560 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5562 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5563 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
5564 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5571 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5573 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5575 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5576 redrawing it, unless REBUILD; in that case, always
5577 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5580 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5581 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5582 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5583 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5584 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5587 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int start
, int end
,
5590 bool dragging
= bar
->dragging
!= -1;
5591 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
5592 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5593 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
5595 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5597 && start
== bar
->start
5604 int inside_width
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f
, bar
->width
);
5605 int inside_height
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f
, bar
->height
);
5606 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
5608 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5609 the distance between start and end. */
5611 int length
= end
- start
;
5615 else if (start
> top_range
)
5617 end
= start
+ length
;
5621 else if (end
> top_range
&& ! dragging
)
5625 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5629 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5630 if (end
> top_range
)
5633 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5634 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5635 that many pixels tall. */
5636 end
+= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
;
5638 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5639 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5640 if ((inside_width
> 0) && (start
> 0))
5641 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5642 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5643 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
,
5644 inside_width
, start
);
5646 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5647 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5648 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5649 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
5651 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5652 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
5653 /* x, y, width, height */
5654 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5655 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ start
,
5656 inside_width
, end
- start
);
5658 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5659 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5660 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5661 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
5663 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5664 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5665 if ((inside_width
> 0) && (end
< inside_height
))
5666 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5667 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5668 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ end
,
5669 inside_width
, inside_height
- end
);
5675 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5677 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5681 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
5683 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5686 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5688 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f
, bar
->x_window
);
5689 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5690 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
));
5691 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5693 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
5696 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5697 if (bar
->horizontal
)
5698 wset_horizontal_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar
->window
), Qnil
);
5700 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar
->window
), Qnil
);
5706 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5707 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5708 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5712 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window
*w
, int portion
, int whole
, int position
)
5714 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
5716 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5717 int top
, height
, left
, width
;
5718 int window_y
, window_height
;
5720 /* Get window dimensions. */
5721 window_box (w
, ANY_AREA
, 0, &window_y
, 0, &window_height
);
5723 height
= window_height
;
5724 left
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
5725 width
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w
);
5727 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5728 if (NILP (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5730 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5733 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5734 left
, top
, width
, height
);
5738 bar
= x_scroll_bar_create (w
, top
, left
, width
, max (height
, 1), false);
5742 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5743 unsigned int mask
= 0;
5745 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
5749 if (left
!= bar
->left
)
5751 if (top
!= bar
->top
)
5753 if (width
!= bar
->width
)
5755 if (height
!= bar
->height
)
5758 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5760 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5763 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5764 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5765 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5766 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5767 left
, top
, width
, height
);
5769 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
, bar
->x_window
, top
,
5770 left
, width
, max (height
, 1));
5771 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5772 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
),
5773 left
, top
, width
, max (height
, 1), 0);
5774 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5776 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5778 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5787 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
,
5791 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5793 /* Remember new settings. */
5797 bar
->height
= height
;
5802 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5803 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5804 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5805 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5807 if (bar
->dragging
== -1)
5809 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, height
);
5812 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, 0, top_range
, false);
5815 int start
= ((double) position
* top_range
) / whole
;
5816 int end
= ((double) (position
+ portion
) * top_range
) / whole
;
5817 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, start
, end
, false);
5820 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5822 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
5823 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w
, barobj
);
5828 XTset_horizontal_scroll_bar (struct window
*w
, int portion
, int whole
, int position
)
5830 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
5832 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5833 int top
, height
, left
, width
;
5834 int window_x
, window_width
;
5835 int pixel_width
= WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (w
);
5837 /* Get window dimensions. */
5838 window_box (w
, ANY_AREA
, &window_x
, 0, &window_width
, 0);
5840 width
= window_width
;
5841 top
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_Y (w
);
5842 height
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_HEIGHT (w
);
5844 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5845 if (NILP (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
))
5847 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5851 /* Clear also part between window_width and
5852 WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH. */
5853 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5854 left
, top
, pixel_width
, height
);
5858 bar
= x_scroll_bar_create (w
, top
, left
, width
, height
, true);
5862 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5863 unsigned int mask
= 0;
5865 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
);
5869 if (left
!= bar
->left
)
5871 if (top
!= bar
->top
)
5873 if (width
!= bar
->width
)
5875 if (height
!= bar
->height
)
5878 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5879 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5882 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5883 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5884 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5885 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5886 WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w
), top
,
5887 pixel_width
- WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w
), height
);
5889 xg_update_horizontal_scrollbar_pos (f
, bar
->x_window
, top
, left
,
5891 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5892 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
),
5893 left
, top
, width
, height
, 0);
5894 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5896 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5898 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5899 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5900 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5903 int area_height
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_HEIGHT (w
);
5904 int rest
= area_height
- height
;
5905 if (rest
> 0 && width
> 0)
5906 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5907 left
, top
, width
, rest
);
5910 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5919 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
,
5923 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5925 /* Remember new settings. */
5929 bar
->height
= height
;
5934 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5935 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5936 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5937 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5939 if (bar
->dragging
== -1)
5941 int left_range
= HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f
, width
);
5944 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, 0, left_range
, false);
5947 int start
= ((double) position
* left_range
) / whole
;
5948 int end
= ((double) (position
+ portion
) * left_range
) / whole
;
5949 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, start
, end
, false);
5952 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5954 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
5955 wset_horizontal_scroll_bar (w
, barobj
);
5959 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5960 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5961 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5962 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5963 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5964 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5965 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5967 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5968 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5969 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5972 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (struct frame
*frame
)
5974 if (!NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5976 if (!NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5978 /* Prepend scrollbars to already condemned ones. */
5979 Lisp_Object last
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5981 while (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (last
)->next
))
5982 last
= XSCROLL_BAR (last
)->next
;
5984 XSCROLL_BAR (last
)->next
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5985 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
))->prev
= last
;
5988 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame
, FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
));
5989 fset_scroll_bars (frame
, Qnil
);
5994 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5995 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5998 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window
*w
)
6000 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
6004 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
6005 if (NILP (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
) && NILP (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
))
6008 if (!NILP (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
) && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w
))
6010 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
6011 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
6012 f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
6013 if (NILP (bar
->prev
))
6015 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
6017 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), w
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
6018 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
6020 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
),
6021 w
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
6022 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f
, bar
->next
);
6024 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
6025 one or the other! */
6029 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->prev
)->next
= bar
->next
;
6031 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
6032 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
= bar
->prev
;
6034 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
6036 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
6037 fset_scroll_bars (f
, barobj
);
6038 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
6039 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
6043 if (!NILP (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
) && WINDOW_HAS_HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR (w
))
6045 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
);
6046 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
6047 f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
6048 if (NILP (bar
->prev
))
6050 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
6052 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
))
6053 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
6055 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
),
6056 w
->horizontal_scroll_bar
))
6057 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f
, bar
->next
);
6059 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
6060 one or the other! */
6064 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->prev
)->next
= bar
->next
;
6066 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
6067 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
= bar
->prev
;
6069 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
6071 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
6072 fset_scroll_bars (f
, barobj
);
6073 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
6074 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
6078 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
6079 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
6082 XTjudge_scroll_bars (struct frame
*f
)
6084 Lisp_Object bar
, next
;
6086 bar
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
6088 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
6089 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
6090 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f
, Qnil
);
6092 for (; ! NILP (bar
); bar
= next
)
6094 struct scroll_bar
*b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
6096 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
6099 b
->next
= b
->prev
= Qnil
;
6102 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
6103 and they should get garbage-collected. */
6107 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6108 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
6109 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
6111 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6115 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, const XEvent
*event
)
6117 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
6118 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
6119 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
6123 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, bar
->start
, bar
->end
, true);
6125 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
6126 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
6127 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
6128 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
6130 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
6131 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
6132 /* x, y, width, height */
6133 0, 0, bar
->width
- 1, bar
->height
- 1);
6135 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
6136 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
6137 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
6138 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
6143 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6145 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
6146 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
6148 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6153 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar
*bar
,
6154 const XEvent
*event
,
6155 struct input_event
*emacs_event
)
6157 if (! WINDOWP (bar
->window
))
6160 emacs_event
->kind
= (bar
->horizontal
6161 ? HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
6162 : SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
);
6163 emacs_event
->code
= event
->xbutton
.button
- Button1
;
6164 emacs_event
->modifiers
6165 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO
6166 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)))),
6167 event
->xbutton
.state
)
6168 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
6171 emacs_event
->frame_or_window
= bar
->window
;
6172 emacs_event
->arg
= Qnil
;
6173 emacs_event
->timestamp
= event
->xbutton
.time
;
6174 if (bar
->horizontal
)
6177 = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f
, bar
->width
);
6178 int x
= event
->xbutton
.x
- HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
;
6181 if (x
> left_range
) x
= left_range
;
6184 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_before_handle
;
6185 else if (x
< bar
->end
+ HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
6186 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_horizontal_handle
;
6188 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_after_handle
;
6190 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6191 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
6192 if (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
&& bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6194 int new_start
= - bar
->dragging
;
6195 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
6197 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, false);
6202 XSETINT (emacs_event
->x
, left_range
);
6203 XSETINT (emacs_event
->y
, x
);
6208 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
6209 int y
= event
->xbutton
.y
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
6212 if (y
> top_range
) y
= top_range
;
6215 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
6216 else if (y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
6217 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
6219 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
6221 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6222 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
6223 if (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
&& bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6225 int new_start
= y
- bar
->dragging
;
6226 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
6228 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, false);
6233 XSETINT (emacs_event
->x
, y
);
6234 XSETINT (emacs_event
->y
, top_range
);
6238 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6240 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
6242 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6246 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar
*bar
,
6247 const XMotionEvent
*event
)
6249 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)->frame
);
6250 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
6252 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->time
;
6253 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= bar
;
6254 f
->mouse_moved
= true;
6256 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
6257 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6259 /* Where should the handle be now? */
6260 int new_start
= event
->y
- bar
->dragging
;
6262 if (new_start
!= bar
->start
)
6264 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
6266 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, false);
6271 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6273 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
6274 on the scroll bar. */
6277 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**fp
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
,
6278 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
,
6279 Lisp_Object
*y
, Time
*timestamp
)
6281 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
);
6282 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
;
6283 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
6284 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
6286 Window dummy_window
;
6288 unsigned int dummy_mask
;
6292 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
6294 if (XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
6296 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
6297 &dummy_window
, &dummy_window
,
6298 &dummy_coord
, &dummy_coord
,
6300 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
6303 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
6306 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
6308 win_y
-= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
6310 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6311 win_y
-= bar
->dragging
;
6315 if (win_y
> top_range
)
6319 *bar_window
= bar
->window
;
6321 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6322 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
6323 else if (win_y
< bar
->start
)
6324 *part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
6325 else if (win_y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
6326 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
6328 *part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
6330 XSETINT (*x
, win_y
);
6331 XSETINT (*y
, top_range
);
6333 f
->mouse_moved
= false;
6334 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= NULL
;
6335 *timestamp
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_movement_time
;
6342 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
6343 on the scroll bar. */
6346 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**fp
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
,
6347 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
,
6348 Lisp_Object
*y
, Time
*timestamp
)
6350 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
);
6351 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
;
6352 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
6353 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
6355 Window dummy_window
;
6357 unsigned int dummy_mask
;
6361 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
6363 if (XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
6365 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
6366 &dummy_window
, &dummy_window
,
6367 &dummy_coord
, &dummy_coord
,
6369 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
6372 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
6375 int left_range
= HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f
, bar
->width
);
6377 win_x
-= HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
;
6379 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6380 win_x
-= bar
->dragging
;
6384 if (win_x
> left_range
)
6388 *bar_window
= bar
->window
;
6390 if (bar
->dragging
!= -1)
6391 *part
= scroll_bar_horizontal_handle
;
6392 else if (win_x
< bar
->start
)
6393 *part
= scroll_bar_before_handle
;
6394 else if (win_x
< bar
->end
+ HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
6395 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
6397 *part
= scroll_bar_after_handle
;
6399 XSETINT (*y
, win_x
);
6400 XSETINT (*x
, left_range
);
6402 f
->mouse_moved
= false;
6403 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_scroll_bar
= NULL
;
6404 *timestamp
= dpyinfo
->last_mouse_movement_time
;
6411 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
6412 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
6413 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
6417 x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame
*f
)
6419 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6422 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
6423 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
6424 But in that case we should not clear them. */
6425 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f
))
6426 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); VECTORP (bar
);
6427 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
6428 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
6429 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
,
6431 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6434 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
6436 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
6437 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
6439 static int temp_index
;
6440 static short temp_buffer
[100];
6442 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
6443 if (temp_index == ARRAYELTS (temp_buffer)) \
6445 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
6447 #else /* not ENABLE_CHECKING */
6449 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) ((void)0)
6451 #endif /* ENABLE_CHECKING */
6453 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
6454 on a particular display. */
6456 static struct x_display_info
*XTread_socket_fake_io_error
;
6458 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
6459 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
6460 We try all the open displays, one by one.
6461 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
6463 static struct x_display_info
*next_noop_dpyinfo
;
6472 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
6473 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
6474 EVENT is the X event to filter.
6476 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
6478 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
6482 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, XEvent
*event
)
6484 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
6485 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
6486 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
6489 struct frame
*f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
6490 event
->xclient
.window
);
6492 return XFilterEvent (event
, f1
? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1
) : None
);
6497 static int current_count
;
6498 static int current_finish
;
6499 static struct input_event
*current_hold_quit
;
6501 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
6502 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
6503 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
6504 static GdkFilterReturn
6505 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent
*gxev
, GdkEvent
*ev
, gpointer data
)
6507 XEvent
*xev
= (XEvent
*) gxev
;
6510 if (current_count
>= 0)
6512 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
6514 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (xev
->xany
.display
);
6517 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
6518 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
6519 so we do it here. */
6520 if ((xev
->type
== KeyPress
|| xev
->type
== KeyRelease
)
6522 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo
, xev
))
6525 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
6530 current_finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
6533 += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, xev
, ¤t_finish
,
6537 current_finish
= x_dispatch_event (xev
, xev
->xany
.display
);
6541 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
|| current_finish
== X_EVENT_DROP
)
6542 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
6544 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE
;
6546 #endif /* USE_GTK */
6549 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame
*f
, Time
,
6550 enum xembed_message
,
6551 long detail
, long data1
, long data2
);
6554 x_net_wm_state (struct frame
*f
, Window window
)
6556 int value
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
6557 Lisp_Object lval
= Qnil
;
6558 bool sticky
= false;
6560 get_current_wm_state (f
, window
, &value
, &sticky
);
6564 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
6567 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
6570 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
6573 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
6578 store_frame_param (f
, Qfullscreen
, lval
);
6579 /** store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil); **/
6582 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
6584 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
6585 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
6586 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
6587 *EVENT is unchanged unless we're processing KeyPress event.
6589 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
6592 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
,
6593 const XEvent
*event
,
6594 int *finish
, struct input_event
*hold_quit
)
6597 struct input_event ie
;
6598 struct selection_input_event sie
;
6602 ptrdiff_t nbytes
= 0;
6603 struct frame
*any
, *f
= NULL
;
6604 struct coding_system coding
;
6605 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
6606 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
6607 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
6608 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
6609 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay. */
6610 static XComposeStatus compose_status
;
6614 *finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
6616 EVENT_INIT (inev
.ie
);
6617 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
;
6620 any
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xany
.window
);
6622 if (any
&& any
->wait_event_type
== event
->type
)
6623 any
->wait_event_type
= 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
6625 switch (event
->type
)
6629 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_protocols
6630 && event
->xclient
.format
== 32)
6632 if (event
->xclient
.data
.l
[0] == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_take_focus
)
6634 /* Use the value returned by x_any_window_to_frame
6635 because this could be the shell widget window
6636 if the frame has no title bar. */
6639 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
6640 if (f
&& FRAME_XIC (f
))
6641 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f
));
6644 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
6645 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
6646 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
6647 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
6648 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
6651 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
6652 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
6653 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
6654 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
6657 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
6658 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
6659 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
6662 Display
*d
= event
->xclient
.display
;
6663 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
6664 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
6666 XSetInputFocus (d
, event
->xclient
.window
,
6667 /* The ICCCM says this is
6668 the only valid choice. */
6670 event
->xclient
.data
.l
[1]);
6671 /* This is needed to detect the error
6672 if there is an error. */
6674 x_uncatch_errors ();
6676 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
6681 if (event
->xclient
.data
.l
[0] == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
)
6683 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
6684 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
6685 the session manager, who's looking for such a
6686 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
6687 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
6688 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
6689 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
6690 session manager and one for this. */
6692 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
6695 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
6696 event
->xclient
.window
);
6697 /* This is just so we only give real data once
6698 for a single Emacs process. */
6699 if (f
== SELECTED_FRAME ())
6700 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
6701 event
->xclient
.window
,
6702 initial_argv
, initial_argc
);
6704 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
6705 event
->xclient
.window
,
6711 if (event
->xclient
.data
.l
[0] == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_delete_window
)
6715 goto OTHER
; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
6717 inev
.ie
.kind
= DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT
;
6718 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6725 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
)
6728 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_window_moved
)
6731 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xclient
.window
);
6733 new_x
= event
->xclient
.data
.s
[0];
6734 new_y
= event
->xclient
.data
.s
[1];
6738 f
->left_pos
= new_x
;
6745 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_editres
)
6749 _XEditResCheckMessages (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
,
6750 NULL
, (XEvent
*) event
, NULL
);
6753 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6755 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_DONE
6756 || event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_PAGE
)
6758 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6759 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6760 currently never do because we are interested in
6761 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6762 Pixmap pixmap
= (Pixmap
) event
->xclient
.data
.l
[1];
6763 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xclient
.window
);
6766 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap
, f
);
6767 expose_frame (f
, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6771 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6772 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6773 we construct an input_event. */
6774 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_Scrollbar
)
6776 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event
, &inev
.ie
);
6777 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
6780 else if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar
)
6782 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event
, &inev
.ie
);
6783 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
6786 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6788 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6789 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
)
6791 enum xembed_message msg
= event
->xclient
.data
.l
[1];
6792 if (msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_IN
|| msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT
)
6793 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, any
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
6795 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
6799 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, event
);
6804 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f
, &event
->xclient
, dpyinfo
, &inev
.ie
))
6805 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6809 case SelectionNotify
:
6810 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xselection
.time
);
6811 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6812 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xselection
.requestor
))
6814 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6815 x_handle_selection_notify (&event
->xselection
);
6818 case SelectionClear
: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6819 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xselectionclear
.time
);
6820 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6821 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xselectionclear
.window
))
6823 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6825 const XSelectionClearEvent
*eventp
= &event
->xselectionclear
;
6827 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT
;
6828 SELECTION_EVENT_DPYINFO (&inev
.sie
) = dpyinfo
;
6829 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
6830 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
6834 case SelectionRequest
: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6835 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xselectionrequest
.time
);
6836 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6837 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xselectionrequest
.owner
))
6839 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6841 const XSelectionRequestEvent
*eventp
= &event
->xselectionrequest
;
6843 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT
;
6844 SELECTION_EVENT_DPYINFO (&inev
.sie
) = dpyinfo
;
6845 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->requestor
;
6846 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
6847 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->target
;
6848 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->property
;
6849 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
6853 case PropertyNotify
:
6854 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xproperty
.time
);
6855 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xproperty
.window
);
6856 if (f
&& event
->xproperty
.atom
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
)
6858 bool not_hidden
= x_handle_net_wm_state (f
, &event
->xproperty
);
6859 if (not_hidden
&& FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
6861 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed.
6862 It hides the frame. So if our state says we aren't
6863 hidden anymore, treat it as deiconified. */
6864 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 1);
6865 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, false);
6866 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= true;
6867 inev
.ie
.kind
= DEICONIFY_EVENT
;
6868 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6870 else if (! not_hidden
&& ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
6872 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
6873 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, true);
6874 inev
.ie
.kind
= ICONIFY_EVENT
;
6875 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6879 x_handle_property_notify (&event
->xproperty
);
6880 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, event
);
6883 case ReparentNotify
:
6884 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xreparent
.window
);
6887 f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
= event
->xreparent
.parent
;
6888 x_real_positions (f
, &f
->left_pos
, &f
->top_pos
);
6890 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6891 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
6892 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->net_supported_window
= 0;
6894 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
6899 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xexpose
.window
);
6902 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
6904 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 1);
6905 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, false);
6906 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= true;
6907 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6912 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6 and later, see
6913 http://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=15398. */
6914 x_clear_area (event
->xexpose
.display
,
6915 event
->xexpose
.window
,
6916 event
->xexpose
.x
, event
->xexpose
.y
,
6917 event
->xexpose
.width
, event
->xexpose
.height
);
6919 expose_frame (f
, event
->xexpose
.x
, event
->xexpose
.y
,
6920 event
->xexpose
.width
, event
->xexpose
.height
);
6925 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6926 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
6928 #if defined USE_LUCID
6929 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6930 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6931 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6933 Widget widget
= x_window_to_menu_bar (event
->xexpose
.window
);
6935 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget
);
6937 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6939 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6940 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6942 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6943 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
->xexpose
.display
,
6944 event
->xexpose
.window
, 2);
6947 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar
, event
);
6948 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6951 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6952 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6956 case GraphicsExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6957 source area was obscured or not
6959 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xgraphicsexpose
.drawable
);
6961 expose_frame (f
, event
->xgraphicsexpose
.x
,
6962 event
->xgraphicsexpose
.y
,
6963 event
->xgraphicsexpose
.width
,
6964 event
->xgraphicsexpose
.height
);
6965 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6968 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6971 case NoExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6972 source area was completely
6977 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6978 if (event
->xunmap
.window
== tip_window
)
6981 x_redo_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo
);
6984 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xunmap
.window
);
6985 if (f
) /* F may no longer exist if
6986 the frame was deleted. */
6988 bool visible
= FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
);
6989 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6990 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6991 display that won't ever be seen. */
6992 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
6993 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6994 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6995 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6996 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6997 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6998 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6999 if (visible
|| FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
7001 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, true);
7002 inev
.ie
.kind
= ICONIFY_EVENT
;
7003 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
7009 if (event
->xmap
.window
== tip_window
)
7010 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
7011 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
7014 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
7015 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
7016 frame is visible. */
7017 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xmap
.window
);
7020 bool iconified
= FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
);
7022 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
7023 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
7024 if (!f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
)
7025 x_check_fullscreen (f
);
7027 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 1);
7028 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, false);
7029 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= true;
7033 inev
.ie
.kind
= DEICONIFY_EVENT
;
7034 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
7036 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list
) && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
7037 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later to update the
7038 frame titles in case this is the second frame. */
7039 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
7042 xg_frame_resized (f
, -1, -1);
7049 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xkey
.time
);
7050 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
7052 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7053 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
7054 if (popup_activated ())
7060 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7061 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
7062 mouse highlighting. */
7063 if (!hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
&& INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight
)
7065 || !EQ (f
->tool_bar_window
, hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
)))
7067 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
7068 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= true;
7072 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7075 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
7076 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
7077 Widget widget
= XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo
->display
,
7078 event
->xkey
.window
);
7079 if (widget
&& XmIsScrollBar (widget
))
7081 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
7082 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, XtWindow (widget
));
7085 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7089 KeySym keysym
, orig_keysym
;
7090 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
7091 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
7094 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
7095 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
7096 status_return even if the input is too long to
7097 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
7098 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
7099 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
7100 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
7101 unsigned char copy_buffer
[513];
7102 unsigned char *copy_bufptr
= copy_buffer
;
7103 int copy_bufsiz
= sizeof (copy_buffer
);
7105 Lisp_Object coding_system
= Qlatin_1
;
7107 /* Event will be modified. */
7108 XKeyEvent xkey
= event
->xkey
;
7111 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
7112 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
7113 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is nonzero
7115 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
7118 xkey
.state
|= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
7119 extra_keyboard_modifiers
);
7120 modifiers
= xkey
.state
;
7122 /* This will have to go some day... */
7124 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
7125 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
7126 xkey
.state
&= ~ControlMask
;
7127 xkey
.state
&= ~(dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
7128 | dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
7129 | dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
7130 | dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
);
7132 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
7133 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
7134 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
7135 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
7136 not it is combined with Meta. */
7137 if (modifiers
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
7138 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
7143 Status status_return
;
7145 coding_system
= Vlocale_coding_system
;
7146 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
7147 &xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
7148 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
7150 if (status_return
== XBufferOverflow
)
7152 copy_bufsiz
= nbytes
+ 1;
7153 copy_bufptr
= alloca (copy_bufsiz
);
7154 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
7155 &xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
7156 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
7159 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
7160 if (status_return
== XLookupNone
)
7162 else if (status_return
== XLookupChars
)
7167 else if (status_return
!= XLookupKeySym
7168 && status_return
!= XLookupBoth
)
7172 nbytes
= XLookupString (&xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
7173 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
7176 nbytes
= XLookupString (&xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
7177 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
7181 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
7182 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
7183 if (compose_status
.chars_matched
> 0 && nbytes
== 0)
7186 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
7187 orig_keysym
= keysym
;
7189 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
7190 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
7192 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
), modifiers
);
7193 inev
.ie
.timestamp
= xkey
.time
;
7195 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
7196 translations to characters. */
7197 if (keysym
>= 32 && keysym
< 128)
7198 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
7200 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
7201 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
7205 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
7206 if (keysym
>= 0x01000000 && keysym
<= 0x0110FFFF)
7208 if (keysym
< 0x01000080)
7209 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
7211 inev
.ie
.kind
= MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
7212 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
& 0xFFFFFF;
7216 /* Now non-ASCII. */
7217 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table
)
7218 && (c
= Fgethash (make_number (keysym
),
7223 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c
))
7224 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
7225 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
7226 inev
.ie
.code
= XFASTINT (c
);
7230 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
7231 if (((keysym
>= XK_BackSpace
&& keysym
<= XK_Escape
)
7232 || keysym
== XK_Delete
7233 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
7234 || (keysym
>= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
7235 && keysym
<= XK_ISO_Enter
)
7237 || IsCursorKey (keysym
) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
7238 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
7240 /* This recognizes the "extended function
7241 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
7242 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
7243 mode_switch incorrectly. */
7244 || (XK_Select
<= keysym
&& keysym
< XK_KP_Space
)
7246 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
7247 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_circumflex
7249 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
7250 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_grave
7252 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
7253 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_tilde
7255 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
7256 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_diaeresis
7258 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
7259 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_macron
7261 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
7262 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_degree
7264 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
7265 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_acute
7267 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
7268 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_cedilla
7270 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
7271 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_breve
7273 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
7274 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_ogonek
7276 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
7277 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_caron
7279 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
7280 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_doubleacute
7282 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
7283 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_abovedot
7285 || IsKeypadKey (keysym
) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
7286 || IsFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
7287 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
7288 || (orig_keysym
& (1 << 28))
7289 || (keysym
!= NoSymbol
&& nbytes
== 0))
7290 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym
)
7291 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
7292 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
7293 don't have real modifiers but
7294 should be treated similarly to
7295 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
7296 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
7297 || (XK_ISO_Lock
<= orig_keysym
7298 && orig_keysym
<= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
)
7302 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym
);
7303 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
7305 inev
.ie
.kind
= NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
7306 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
7310 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
7314 for (i
= 0, nchars
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
++)
7316 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (copy_bufptr
[i
]))
7318 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr
[i
]);
7321 if (nchars
< nbytes
)
7323 /* Decode the input data. */
7325 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
7326 which depends on which X*LookupString function
7327 we used just above and the locale. */
7328 setup_coding_system (coding_system
, &coding
);
7329 coding
.src_multibyte
= false;
7330 coding
.dst_multibyte
= true;
7331 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
7332 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
7333 gives us composition information. */
7334 coding
.common_flags
&= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK
;
7336 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding
.destination
, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH
,
7338 coding
.dst_bytes
= MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH
* nbytes
;
7339 coding
.mode
|= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK
;
7340 decode_coding_c_string (&coding
, copy_bufptr
, nbytes
, Qnil
);
7341 nbytes
= coding
.produced
;
7342 nchars
= coding
.produced_char
;
7343 copy_bufptr
= coding
.destination
;
7346 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
7347 character events. */
7348 for (i
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
+= len
)
7351 if (nchars
== nbytes
)
7352 ch
= copy_bufptr
[i
], len
= 1;
7354 ch
= STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr
+ i
, len
);
7355 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch
)
7356 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
7357 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
7359 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
7364 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
; /* Already stored above. */
7366 if (keysym
== NoSymbol
)
7369 /* FIXME: check side effects and remove this. */
7370 ((XEvent
*) event
)->xkey
= xkey
;
7374 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
7375 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
7383 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xkey
.time
);
7385 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
7386 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
7394 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xcrossing
.time
);
7395 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, any
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7399 if (f
&& x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
)
7400 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= event
->xmotion
.time
+ 200;
7402 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
7403 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
7404 if (f
&& !f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_p
)
7405 note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
->xmotion
);
7407 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
7408 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
7409 if (!f
&& dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
7410 note_mouse_movement (dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
->xmotion
);
7415 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, any
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7419 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xcrossing
.time
);
7420 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, any
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7422 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xcrossing
.window
);
7425 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
7427 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
7428 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
7429 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
7430 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
7433 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
7434 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
7435 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
7436 the mouse leaves the frame. */
7437 if (any_help_event_p
)
7441 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
7442 else if (dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
7443 note_mouse_movement (dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
->xmotion
);
7448 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, any
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7453 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xmotion
.time
);
7454 previous_help_echo_string
= help_echo_string
;
7455 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
7457 f
= (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo
) ? dpyinfo
->last_mouse_frame
7458 : x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xmotion
.window
));
7460 if (hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
)
7462 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= false;
7463 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
7467 if (f
&& xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f
, event
))
7473 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
7474 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
7475 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window
) && !popup_activated ())
7477 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_window
;
7478 Lisp_Object window
= window_from_coordinates
7479 (f
, event
->xmotion
.x
, event
->xmotion
.y
, 0, false);
7481 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
7482 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
7483 will be selected only when it is active. */
7484 if (WINDOWP (window
)
7485 && !EQ (window
, last_mouse_window
)
7486 && !EQ (window
, selected_window
)
7487 /* For click-to-focus window managers
7488 create event iff we don't leave the
7490 && (focus_follows_mouse
7491 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window
)->frame
,
7492 XWINDOW (selected_window
)->frame
))))
7494 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT
;
7495 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= window
;
7497 /* Remember the last window where we saw the mouse. */
7498 last_mouse_window
= window
;
7500 if (!note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
->xmotion
))
7501 help_echo_string
= previous_help_echo_string
;
7505 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7506 struct scroll_bar
*bar
7507 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
->xmotion
.display
,
7508 event
->xmotion
.window
, 2);
7511 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar
, &event
->xmotion
);
7512 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7514 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
7515 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
7516 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
7519 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
7520 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
7521 if (!NILP (help_echo_string
)
7522 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string
))
7527 case ConfigureNotify
:
7528 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xconfigure
.window
);
7532 && event
->xconfigure
.window
== FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
7534 xg_frame_resized (f
, event
->xconfigure
.width
,
7535 event
->xconfigure
.height
);
7541 x_net_wm_state (f
, event
->xconfigure
.window
);
7543 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7545 int width
= FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_WIDTH (f
, event
->xconfigure
.width
);
7546 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_HEIGHT (f
, event
->xconfigure
.height
);
7548 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
7549 is called by the code that handles resizing
7550 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
7552 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
7553 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
7554 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
7555 if (width
!= FRAME_TEXT_WIDTH (f
)
7556 || height
!= FRAME_TEXT_HEIGHT (f
)
7557 || event
->xconfigure
.width
!= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
7558 || event
->xconfigure
.height
!= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
))
7560 change_frame_size (f
, width
, height
, false, true, false, true);
7561 x_clear_under_internal_border (f
);
7562 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
7563 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
7565 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7569 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
7570 Only get real positions when mapped. */
7571 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)
7572 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)))
7574 x_real_positions (f
, &f
->left_pos
, &f
->top_pos
);
7577 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
))
7578 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
7587 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
7588 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
7589 bool tool_bar_p
= false;
7591 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
7592 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_glyph_frame
= NULL
;
7593 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo
, event
->xbutton
.time
);
7595 f
= (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo
) ? dpyinfo
->last_mouse_frame
7596 : x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xbutton
.window
));
7599 if (f
&& xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f
, event
))
7604 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7605 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
7606 if (WINDOWP (f
->tool_bar_window
)
7607 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f
->tool_bar_window
)))
7610 int x
= event
->xbutton
.x
;
7611 int y
= event
->xbutton
.y
;
7613 window
= window_from_coordinates (f
, x
, y
, 0, true);
7614 tool_bar_p
= EQ (window
, f
->tool_bar_window
);
7616 if (tool_bar_p
&& event
->xbutton
.button
< 4)
7617 handle_tool_bar_click
7618 (f
, x
, y
, event
->xbutton
.type
== ButtonPress
,
7619 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo
, event
->xbutton
.state
));
7621 #endif /* !USE_GTK */
7624 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7625 if (! popup_activated ())
7628 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
)
7630 if (event
->type
== ButtonPress
7631 && event
->xbutton
.time
> ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
)
7633 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
7634 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
->xbutton
, f
);
7636 if (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
)
7637 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
7640 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
->xbutton
, f
);
7642 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
7643 xembed_send_message (f
, event
->xbutton
.time
,
7644 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
, 0, 0, 0);
7648 struct scroll_bar
*bar
7649 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
->xbutton
.display
,
7650 event
->xbutton
.window
, 2);
7652 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7653 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
7655 if (bar
&& event
->xbutton
.state
& ControlMask
)
7657 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7658 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
7660 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7662 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, event
, &inev
.ie
);
7663 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7666 if (event
->type
== ButtonPress
)
7668 dpyinfo
->grabbed
|= (1 << event
->xbutton
.button
);
7669 dpyinfo
->last_mouse_frame
= f
;
7670 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7671 if (f
&& !tool_bar_p
)
7672 f
->last_tool_bar_item
= -1;
7673 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7676 dpyinfo
->grabbed
&= ~(1 << event
->xbutton
.button
);
7678 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
7679 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
7680 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
7682 f
->mouse_moved
= false;
7684 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7685 f
= x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
);
7686 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
7687 don't pass it to Xt right now.
7688 Instead, save it away
7689 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
7690 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
7691 if (! popup_activated ()
7693 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
7694 && event
->xbutton
.button
< 3
7696 && f
&& event
->type
== ButtonPress
7697 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
7698 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
7699 && event
->xbutton
.x
>= 0
7700 && event
->xbutton
.x
< FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
7701 && event
->xbutton
.y
>= 0
7702 && event
->xbutton
.y
< FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
)
7703 && event
->xbutton
.same_screen
)
7705 if (!f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
)
7706 f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
= xmalloc (sizeof *event
);
7707 *f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
= *event
;
7708 inev
.ie
.kind
= MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT
;
7709 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
7710 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
7714 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7718 case CirculateNotify
:
7721 case CirculateRequest
:
7724 case VisibilityNotify
:
7728 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7730 switch (event
->xmapping
.request
)
7732 case MappingModifier
:
7733 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
7734 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7735 case MappingKeyboard
:
7736 XRefreshKeyboardMapping ((XMappingEvent
*) &event
->xmapping
);
7741 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, event
);
7746 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7748 if (*finish
!= X_EVENT_DROP
)
7749 XtDispatchEvent ((XEvent
*) event
);
7751 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7756 if (inev
.ie
.kind
!= NO_EVENT
)
7758 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
7763 && !(hold_quit
&& hold_quit
->kind
!= NO_EVENT
))
7768 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
7774 any_help_event_p
= true;
7775 gen_help_event (help_echo_string
, frame
, help_echo_window
,
7776 help_echo_object
, help_echo_pos
);
7780 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
7781 gen_help_event (Qnil
, frame
, Qnil
, Qnil
, 0);
7790 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7791 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7792 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7794 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7796 x_dispatch_event (XEvent
*event
, Display
*display
)
7798 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
7799 int finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
7801 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (display
);
7804 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, event
, &finish
, 0);
7809 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7810 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7812 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7813 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7814 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7818 XTread_socket (struct terminal
*terminal
, struct input_event
*hold_quit
)
7821 bool event_found
= false;
7822 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= terminal
->display_info
.x
;
7826 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7827 if (dpyinfo
== XTread_socket_fake_io_error
)
7829 XTread_socket_fake_io_error
= 0;
7830 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo
->display
);
7834 while (XPending (dpyinfo
->display
))
7839 XNextEvent (dpyinfo
->display
, &event
);
7842 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7843 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo
, &event
))
7848 count
+= handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, &event
, &finish
, hold_quit
);
7850 if (finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7856 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7857 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7858 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7859 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7861 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7862 from all displays. */
7864 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7866 current_count
= count
;
7867 current_hold_quit
= hold_quit
;
7869 gtk_main_iteration ();
7871 count
= current_count
;
7873 current_hold_quit
= 0;
7875 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7878 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7880 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7881 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7884 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7885 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7886 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7888 if (x_noop_count
>= 100)
7892 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== 0)
7893 next_noop_dpyinfo
= x_display_list
;
7895 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo
->display
);
7897 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7898 next_noop_dpyinfo
= next_noop_dpyinfo
->next
;
7902 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7903 raise it now. FIXME: handle more than one such frame. */
7904 if (dpyinfo
->x_pending_autoraise_frame
)
7906 x_raise_frame (dpyinfo
->x_pending_autoraise_frame
);
7907 dpyinfo
->x_pending_autoraise_frame
= NULL
;
7918 /***********************************************************************
7920 ***********************************************************************/
7922 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7923 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7925 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7926 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7927 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7930 x_clip_to_row (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
,
7931 enum glyph_row_area area
, GC gc
)
7933 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7934 XRectangle clip_rect
;
7935 int window_x
, window_y
, window_width
;
7937 window_box (w
, area
, &window_x
, &window_y
, &window_width
, 0);
7939 clip_rect
.x
= window_x
;
7940 clip_rect
.y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, row
->y
));
7941 clip_rect
.y
= max (clip_rect
.y
, window_y
);
7942 clip_rect
.width
= window_width
;
7943 clip_rect
.height
= row
->visible_height
;
7945 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
, 0, 0, &clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
7949 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7952 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
)
7954 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7955 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
7956 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
7959 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
7962 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7963 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7964 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
7965 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
7968 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7969 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w
, row
, cursor_glyph
, &x
, &y
, &h
);
7970 wd
= w
->phys_cursor_width
- 1;
7972 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7973 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7974 xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
7975 if (dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
)
7976 XChangeGC (dpy
, dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7978 dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
7979 GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7980 gc
= dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
;
7982 /* When on R2L character, show cursor at the right edge of the
7983 glyph, unless the cursor box is as wide as the glyph or wider
7984 (the latter happens when x-stretch-cursor is non-nil). */
7985 if ((cursor_glyph
->resolved_level
& 1) != 0
7986 && cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
> wd
)
7988 x
+= cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
- wd
;
7992 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7993 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
7994 XDrawRectangle (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
, x
, y
, wd
, h
- 1);
7995 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
7999 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
8001 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
8002 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
8003 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
8007 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, int width
, enum text_cursor_kinds kind
)
8009 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
8010 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
8012 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
8013 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
8015 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
8016 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
8019 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
8020 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
8021 the bar might not be in the window. */
8022 if (cursor_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
)
8024 struct glyph_row
*r
;
8025 r
= MATRIX_ROW (w
->current_matrix
, w
->phys_cursor
.vpos
);
8026 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, r
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
8030 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
8031 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
8032 GC gc
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
8033 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
8034 struct face
*face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, cursor_glyph
->face_id
);
8037 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
8038 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
8039 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
8040 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
8041 that the glyph is legible. */
8042 if (face
->background
== f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
8043 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= face
->foreground
;
8045 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
8046 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
8049 XChangeGC (dpy
, gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
8052 gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
8053 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
= gc
;
8056 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
8058 if (kind
== BAR_CURSOR
)
8060 int x
= WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
);
8063 width
= FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f
);
8064 width
= min (cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
, width
);
8066 w
->phys_cursor_width
= width
;
8068 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
8069 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
8070 if ((cursor_glyph
->resolved_level
& 1) != 0)
8071 x
+= cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
- width
;
8073 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
, x
,
8074 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
),
8075 width
, row
->height
);
8077 else /* HBAR_CURSOR */
8079 int dummy_x
, dummy_y
, dummy_h
;
8080 int x
= WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
);
8083 width
= row
->height
;
8085 width
= min (row
->height
, width
);
8087 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w
, row
, cursor_glyph
, &dummy_x
,
8088 &dummy_y
, &dummy_h
);
8090 if ((cursor_glyph
->resolved_level
& 1) != 0
8091 && cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
> w
->phys_cursor_width
- 1)
8092 x
+= cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
- w
->phys_cursor_width
+ 1;
8093 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
, x
,
8094 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
+
8095 row
->height
- width
),
8096 w
->phys_cursor_width
- 1, width
);
8099 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
8104 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
8107 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame
*f
, Cursor cursor
)
8109 if (!f
->pointer_invisible
8110 && f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
!= cursor
)
8111 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), cursor
);
8112 f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
= cursor
;
8116 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
8119 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
)
8121 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), x
, y
, width
, height
);
8123 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
8124 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
8125 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
8130 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
8133 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*glyph_row
, int x
,
8134 int y
, enum text_cursor_kinds cursor_type
,
8135 int cursor_width
, bool on_p
, bool active_p
)
8137 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
8141 w
->phys_cursor_type
= cursor_type
;
8142 w
->phys_cursor_on_p
= true;
8144 if (glyph_row
->exact_window_width_line_p
8145 && (glyph_row
->reversed_p
8146 ? (w
->phys_cursor
.hpos
< 0)
8147 : (w
->phys_cursor
.hpos
>= glyph_row
->used
[TEXT_AREA
])))
8149 glyph_row
->cursor_in_fringe_p
= true;
8150 draw_fringe_bitmap (w
, glyph_row
, glyph_row
->reversed_p
);
8154 switch (cursor_type
)
8156 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR
:
8157 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w
, glyph_row
);
8160 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR
:
8161 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, glyph_row
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
8165 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, BAR_CURSOR
);
8169 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, HBAR_CURSOR
);
8173 w
->phys_cursor_width
= 0;
8182 if (w
== XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
))
8183 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
))
8184 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, x
, y
);
8188 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8194 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
8197 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object file
)
8199 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id
;
8201 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
8204 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
8205 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
8206 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
8207 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
8212 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
8213 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
8214 if (xg_set_icon (f
, file
))
8216 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8217 bitmap_id
= x_create_bitmap_from_file (f
, file
);
8218 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, bitmap_id
);
8222 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
8223 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
< 0)
8229 if (xg_set_icon (f
, xg_default_icon_file
)
8230 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
))
8232 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= -2;
8236 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
8238 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
);
8240 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
8244 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
8247 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_data (f
, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits
,
8248 gnu_xbm_width
, gnu_xbm_height
);
8252 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
8253 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
8257 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
8258 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
8259 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
8260 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
8261 x_reference_bitmap (f
, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
8263 bitmap_id
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
;
8266 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, bitmap_id
);
8267 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= bitmap_id
;
8273 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
8274 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
8277 x_text_icon (struct frame
*f
, const char *icon_name
)
8279 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
8284 text
.value
= (unsigned char *) icon_name
;
8285 text
.encoding
= XA_STRING
;
8287 text
.nitems
= strlen (icon_name
);
8288 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
), &text
);
8291 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
8292 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
8293 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
8294 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, 0);
8299 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
8301 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
8302 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
8304 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
8305 be called from a signal handler.
8308 struct x_error_message_stack
{
8309 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
8311 struct x_error_message_stack
*prev
;
8313 static struct x_error_message_stack
*x_error_message
;
8315 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
8316 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
8317 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
8320 x_error_catcher (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
8322 XGetErrorText (display
, event
->error_code
,
8323 x_error_message
->string
,
8324 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
8327 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
8328 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
8331 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
8332 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
8333 stored in *x_error_message.
8335 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
8336 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
8338 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
8341 x_catch_errors (Display
*dpy
)
8343 struct x_error_message_stack
*data
= xmalloc (sizeof *data
);
8345 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
8349 data
->string
[0] = 0;
8350 data
->prev
= x_error_message
;
8351 x_error_message
= data
;
8354 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
8355 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
8358 x_uncatch_errors (void)
8360 struct x_error_message_stack
*tmp
;
8364 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
8365 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
8366 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message
->dpy
) != 0)
8367 XSync (x_error_message
->dpy
, False
);
8369 tmp
= x_error_message
;
8370 x_error_message
= x_error_message
->prev
;
8375 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
8376 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
8377 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
8380 x_check_errors (Display
*dpy
, const char *format
)
8382 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
8385 if (x_error_message
->string
[0])
8387 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
8388 memcpy (string
, x_error_message
->string
, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
8389 x_uncatch_errors ();
8390 error (format
, string
);
8394 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
8395 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
8398 x_had_errors_p (Display
*dpy
)
8400 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
8403 return x_error_message
->string
[0] != 0;
8406 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
8409 x_clear_errors (Display
*dpy
)
8411 x_error_message
->string
[0] = 0;
8415 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
8416 * idea. --lorentey */
8417 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
8420 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
8422 while (x_error_message
)
8423 x_uncatch_errors ();
8428 static unsigned int x_wire_count
;
8431 fprintf (stderr
, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count
);
8436 /************************************************************************
8438 ************************************************************************/
8440 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
8442 static char *error_msg
;
8444 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
8445 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
8448 x_connection_closed (Display
*dpy
, const char *error_message
)
8450 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
8451 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
8452 ptrdiff_t idx
= SPECPDL_INDEX ();
8454 error_msg
= alloca (strlen (error_message
) + 1);
8455 strcpy (error_msg
, error_message
);
8457 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
8458 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay
, Qt
);
8462 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
8464 dpyinfo
->reference_count
++;
8465 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
++;
8468 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
8469 that are on the dead display. */
8470 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8472 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame
;
8474 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame
))));
8475 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
8476 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
))
8477 && ! EQ (frame
, minibuf_frame
)
8478 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
8479 delete_frame (frame
, Qnoelisp
);
8482 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
8483 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
8484 for another frame that we need to delete. */
8485 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8486 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
8487 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
8489 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
8490 trying to find a replacement. */
8491 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame
)), Qt
);
8492 delete_frame (frame
, Qnoelisp
);
8495 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
8496 first place, so don't try to close it. */
8499 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
8500 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
8501 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
8503 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
8504 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
8505 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
8506 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
8507 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil
);
8508 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n\
8509 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
8510 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
8511 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
8514 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8516 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
8517 dpyinfo
->display
= 0;
8519 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
8520 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
--;
8521 if (dpyinfo
->reference_count
!= 0)
8522 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
8527 XSETTERMINAL (tmp
, dpyinfo
->terminal
);
8528 Fdelete_terminal (tmp
, Qnoelisp
);
8532 if (terminal_list
== 0)
8534 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n", error_msg
);
8535 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
8539 totally_unblock_input ();
8541 unbind_to (idx
, Qnil
);
8542 clear_waiting_for_input ();
8544 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
8545 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list
) return; )
8547 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
8548 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
8549 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
8550 error ("%s", error_msg
);
8553 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
8554 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
8555 static void x_error_quitter (Display
*, XErrorEvent
*);
8557 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
8558 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
8561 x_error_handler (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
8563 #if defined USE_GTK && defined HAVE_GTK3
8564 if ((event
->error_code
== BadMatch
|| event
->error_code
== BadWindow
)
8565 && event
->request_code
== X_SetInputFocus
)
8571 if (x_error_message
)
8572 x_error_catcher (display
, event
);
8574 x_error_quitter (display
, event
);
8578 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
8579 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
8580 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8582 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
8584 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
8585 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
8587 static void NO_INLINE
8588 x_error_quitter (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
8590 char buf
[256], buf1
[356];
8592 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
8593 or colors that are not defined. */
8595 if (event
->error_code
== BadName
)
8598 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
8599 original error handler. */
8601 XGetErrorText (display
, event
->error_code
, buf
, sizeof (buf
));
8602 sprintf (buf1
, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
8603 buf
, event
->request_code
);
8604 x_connection_closed (display
, buf1
);
8608 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
8609 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
8610 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8613 x_io_error_quitter (Display
*display
)
8617 snprintf (buf
, sizeof buf
, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
8618 DisplayString (display
));
8619 x_connection_closed (display
, buf
);
8623 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
8625 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
8626 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
8627 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
8631 x_new_font (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object font_object
, int fontset
)
8633 struct font
*font
= XFONT_OBJECT (font_object
);
8637 fontset
= fontset_from_font (font_object
);
8638 FRAME_FONTSET (f
) = fontset
;
8639 if (FRAME_FONT (f
) == font
)
8640 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
8644 FRAME_FONT (f
) = font
;
8645 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f
) = font
->baseline_offset
;
8646 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
) = font
->average_width
;
8647 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
) = FONT_HEIGHT (font
);
8649 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8650 FRAME_MENU_BAR_HEIGHT (f
) = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f
) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
8653 /* Compute character columns occupied by scrollbar.
8655 Don't do things differently for non-toolkit scrollbars
8657 unit
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
8658 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) > 0)
8659 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
)
8660 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) + unit
- 1) / unit
;
8662 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) = (14 + unit
- 1) / unit
;
8664 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) != 0)
8666 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8667 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8668 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8669 if (NILP (tip_frame
) || XFRAME (tip_frame
) != f
)
8670 adjust_frame_size (f
, FRAME_COLS (f
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
),
8671 FRAME_LINES (f
) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
), 3,
8677 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & (XIMPreeditPosition
| XIMStatusArea
)))
8680 xic_set_xfontset (f
, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset
)));
8689 /***********************************************************************
8691 ***********************************************************************/
8697 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8698 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8699 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8702 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim
, XPointer client_data
, XPointer call_data
)
8704 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= (struct x_display_info
*) client_data
;
8705 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
8709 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8710 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8712 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
8713 if (FRAME_X_P (f
) && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
)
8715 FRAME_XIC (f
) = NULL
;
8716 xic_free_xfontset (f
);
8720 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8721 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8722 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
8726 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8728 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8729 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8732 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, char *resource_name
)
8740 XCloseIM (dpyinfo
->xim
);
8741 xim
= XOpenIM (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
, resource_name
,
8748 XIMCallback destroy
;
8751 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8752 XGetIMValues (xim
, XNQueryInputStyle
, &dpyinfo
->xim_styles
, NULL
);
8755 destroy
.callback
= xim_destroy_callback
;
8756 destroy
.client_data
= (XPointer
)dpyinfo
;
8757 XSetIMValues (xim
, XNDestroyCallback
, &destroy
, NULL
);
8763 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8764 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8768 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8770 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8771 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8772 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8773 when the callback was registered. */
8776 xim_instantiate_callback (Display
*display
, XPointer client_data
, XPointer call_data
)
8778 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
= (struct xim_inst_t
*) client_data
;
8779 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= xim_inst
->dpyinfo
;
8781 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8785 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, xim_inst
->resource_name
);
8787 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8788 as they have no XIC. */
8789 if (dpyinfo
->xim
&& dpyinfo
->reference_count
> 0)
8791 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
8794 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8796 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
8799 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == xim_inst
->dpyinfo
)
8800 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) == NULL
)
8802 create_frame_xic (f
);
8803 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
)
8804 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
8805 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
)
8807 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
);
8808 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, w
->cursor
.x
, w
->cursor
.y
);
8817 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8820 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8821 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8822 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8823 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8826 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, char *resource_name
)
8828 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8832 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8833 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
= xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst
);
8836 dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
= xim_inst
;
8837 xim_inst
->dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
;
8838 xim_inst
->resource_name
= xstrdup (resource_name
);
8839 ret
= XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback
8840 (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
, xim_inst
->resource_name
,
8841 emacs_class
, xim_instantiate_callback
,
8842 /* This is XPointer in XFree86 but (XPointer *)
8843 on Tru64, at least, hence the configure test. */
8844 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6
) xim_inst
);
8845 eassert (ret
== True
);
8846 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8847 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
8848 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8850 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8854 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8857 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
8862 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8863 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
= dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
;
8865 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8867 Bool ret
= XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback
8868 (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
, xim_inst
->resource_name
,
8869 emacs_class
, xim_instantiate_callback
,
8870 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6
) xim_inst
);
8871 eassert (ret
== True
);
8873 xfree (xim_inst
->resource_name
);
8875 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8876 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8877 XCloseIM (dpyinfo
->xim
);
8878 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8879 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
8881 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8884 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8888 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8889 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8892 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame
*f
)
8894 int flags
= f
->size_hint_flags
;
8896 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8897 is already for the top-left corner. */
8898 if (! ((flags
& XNegative
) || (flags
& YNegative
)))
8901 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8902 position that fits on the screen. */
8903 if (flags
& XNegative
)
8904 f
->left_pos
= x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
8905 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) + f
->left_pos
;
8908 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8910 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8911 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8912 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8914 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8915 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8916 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8917 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8920 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8921 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8923 XtVaGetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->column_widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
8926 if (flags
& YNegative
)
8927 f
->top_pos
= x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
8928 - height
+ f
->top_pos
;
8931 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8932 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8933 so the flags should correspond. */
8934 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8937 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8938 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8939 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8940 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8941 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8944 x_set_offset (struct frame
*f
, register int xoff
, register int yoff
, int change_gravity
)
8946 int modified_top
, modified_left
;
8948 if (change_gravity
> 0)
8952 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8954 f
->size_hint_flags
|= XNegative
;
8956 f
->size_hint_flags
|= YNegative
;
8957 f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
8959 x_calc_absolute_position (f
);
8962 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, 0, false);
8964 modified_left
= f
->left_pos
;
8965 modified_top
= f
->top_pos
;
8967 if (change_gravity
!= 0 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
)
8969 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8970 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8971 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8972 modified_left
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
8973 modified_top
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
8976 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8977 modified_left
, modified_top
);
8979 x_sync_with_move (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
,
8980 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
);
8982 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8983 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8984 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8985 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8988 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8989 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8990 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8992 if (change_gravity
!= 0
8993 && (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8994 || (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
8995 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
== 0
8996 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
== 0))))
8997 x_check_expected_move (f
, modified_left
, modified_top
);
9002 /* Return true if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
9003 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
9004 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
9005 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9006 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
9009 wm_supports (struct frame
*f
, Atom want_atom
)
9012 unsigned long actual_size
, bytes_remaining
;
9013 int i
, rc
, actual_format
;
9015 Window wmcheck_window
;
9016 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9017 Window target_window
= dpyinfo
->root_window
;
9018 int max_len
= 65536;
9019 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
9020 unsigned char *tmp_data
= NULL
;
9021 Atom target_type
= XA_WINDOW
;
9025 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
9026 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
9027 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check
,
9028 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
9029 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
9030 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
9032 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_WINDOW
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
9034 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
9035 x_uncatch_errors ();
9040 wmcheck_window
= *(Window
*) tmp_data
;
9043 /* Check if window exists. */
9044 XSelectInput (dpy
, wmcheck_window
, StructureNotifyMask
);
9046 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
9048 x_uncatch_errors ();
9053 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
!= wmcheck_window
)
9055 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
9056 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
!= NULL
)
9057 XFree (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
);
9058 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= NULL
;
9059 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= 0;
9060 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= 0;
9062 target_type
= XA_ATOM
;
9064 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
9065 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supported
,
9066 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
9067 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
9068 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
9070 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_ATOM
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
9072 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
9073 x_uncatch_errors ();
9078 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= (Atom
*)tmp_data
;
9079 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= actual_size
;
9080 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= wmcheck_window
;
9085 for (i
= 0; !ret
&& i
< dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
; ++i
)
9086 ret
= dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
[i
] == want_atom
;
9088 x_uncatch_errors ();
9095 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame
, bool add
, Atom atom
, Atom value
)
9097 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame
));
9099 x_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
9100 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
,
9102 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
9106 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom
),
9108 ? list1 (make_fixnum_or_float (value
))
9113 x_set_sticky (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object new_value
, Lisp_Object old_value
)
9116 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9118 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9120 set_wm_state (frame
, !NILP (new_value
),
9121 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
, None
);
9124 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
9125 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
9126 Set *STICKY to the sticky state.
9128 Return true iff we are not hidden. */
9131 get_current_wm_state (struct frame
*f
,
9137 unsigned long actual_size
, bytes_remaining
;
9138 int i
, rc
, actual_format
;
9139 bool is_hidden
= false;
9140 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9141 long max_len
= 65536;
9142 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
9143 unsigned char *tmp_data
= NULL
;
9144 Atom target_type
= XA_ATOM
;
9147 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
9150 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
9151 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, window
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
,
9152 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
9153 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
9154 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
9156 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= target_type
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
9158 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
9159 x_uncatch_errors ();
9161 return !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
);
9164 x_uncatch_errors ();
9166 for (i
= 0; i
< actual_size
; ++i
)
9168 Atom a
= ((Atom
*)tmp_data
)[i
];
9169 if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden
)
9171 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
)
9173 if (*size_state
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
)
9174 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
;
9176 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
;
9178 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
)
9180 if (*size_state
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
)
9181 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
;
9183 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
;
9185 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
)
9186 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_BOTH
;
9187 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
)
9191 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
9196 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
9199 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame
*f
)
9201 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9202 bool have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
);
9206 get_current_wm_state (f
, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
), &cur
, &dummy
);
9208 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
9209 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
9211 have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
);
9213 if (have_net_atom
&& cur
!= f
->want_fullscreen
)
9217 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9219 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
9220 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
9221 are sent at once. */
9222 switch (f
->want_fullscreen
)
9224 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
9225 if (cur
!= FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
9226 set_wm_state (frame
, true, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
9229 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
9230 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
9231 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
9232 set_wm_state (frame
, false, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
9233 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
9234 if (cur
!= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
9235 set_wm_state (frame
, true,
9236 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
, None
);
9238 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
9239 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
9240 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
9241 set_wm_state (frame
, false, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
9242 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
);
9243 if (cur
!= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
9244 set_wm_state (frame
, true,
9245 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
, None
);
9247 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
9248 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
9249 set_wm_state (frame
, false, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
9251 set_wm_state (frame
, true,
9252 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
9253 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
9255 case FULLSCREEN_NONE
:
9256 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
9257 set_wm_state (frame
, false, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
9260 set_wm_state (frame
, false,
9261 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
9262 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
9265 f
->want_fullscreen
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
9269 return have_net_atom
;
9273 XTfullscreen_hook (struct frame
*f
)
9275 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9278 x_check_fullscreen (f
);
9286 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame
*f
, const XPropertyEvent
*event
)
9288 int value
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
9290 bool sticky
= false;
9291 bool not_hidden
= get_current_wm_state (f
, event
->window
, &value
, &sticky
);
9296 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
9299 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
9302 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
9305 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
9310 store_frame_param (f
, Qfullscreen
, lval
);
9311 store_frame_param (f
, Qsticky
, sticky
? Qt
: Qnil
);
9316 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
9317 If so needed, resize the frame. */
9319 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame
*f
)
9321 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f
))
9324 if (f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
!= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
)
9325 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
9327 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
9328 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
9329 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
9331 if (f
->want_fullscreen
!= FULLSCREEN_NONE
)
9333 int width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
), height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
9334 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9336 switch (f
->want_fullscreen
)
9338 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
9339 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
9340 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
9341 width
= x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo
);
9342 height
= x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo
);
9344 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
9345 width
= x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo
);
9347 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
9348 height
= x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo
);
9351 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9356 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
9357 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
9358 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
9359 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
9360 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
9361 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
9362 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
9365 x_check_expected_move (struct frame
*f
, int expected_left
, int expected_top
)
9367 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
9369 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
9370 window manager window around the frame. */
9372 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
9374 if (current_left
!= expected_left
|| current_top
!= expected_top
)
9376 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
9381 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_A
;
9382 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
= expected_left
- current_left
;
9383 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
= expected_top
- current_top
;
9385 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
9387 adjusted_left
= expected_left
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
9388 adjusted_top
= expected_top
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
9390 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9391 adjusted_left
, adjusted_top
);
9393 x_sync_with_move (f
, expected_left
, expected_top
, false);
9396 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
9397 frame's position. */
9399 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_B
;
9403 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
9404 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
9405 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
9406 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
9407 of an exact comparison. */
9410 x_sync_with_move (struct frame
*f
, int left
, int top
, bool fuzzy
)
9414 while (count
++ < 50)
9416 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
9418 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
9419 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
9422 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
9423 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
9427 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
9430 if (eabs (current_left
- left
) <= 10
9431 && eabs (current_top
- top
) <= 40)
9434 else if (current_left
== left
&& current_top
== top
)
9438 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
9439 will then return up-to-date position info. */
9441 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000000, 0, false, Qnil
, NULL
, 0);
9445 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
9447 x_wait_for_event (struct frame
*f
, int eventtype
)
9449 int level
= interrupt_input_blocked
;
9452 struct timespec tmo
, tmo_at
, time_now
;
9453 int fd
= ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9455 f
->wait_event_type
= eventtype
;
9457 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
9458 Maybe it should be configurable. */
9459 tmo
= make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
9460 tmo_at
= timespec_add (current_timespec (), tmo
);
9462 while (f
->wait_event_type
)
9464 pending_signals
= true;
9465 totally_unblock_input ();
9466 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
9468 interrupt_input_blocked
= level
;
9473 time_now
= current_timespec ();
9474 if (timespec_cmp (tmo_at
, time_now
) < 0)
9477 tmo
= timespec_sub (tmo_at
, time_now
);
9478 if (pselect (fd
+ 1, &fds
, NULL
, NULL
, &tmo
, NULL
) == 0)
9479 break; /* Timeout */
9482 f
->wait_event_type
= 0;
9486 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to WIDTH/HEIGHT in the case F
9487 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY, change to
9488 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
9489 size changes. Otherwise leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9492 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame
*f
, bool change_gravity
,
9493 int width
, int height
, bool pixelwise
)
9495 int pixelwidth
, pixelheight
;
9497 pixelwidth
= (pixelwise
9498 ? FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, width
)
9499 : FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, width
));
9500 pixelheight
= ((pixelwise
9501 ? FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, height
)
9502 : FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, height
)));
9504 if (change_gravity
) f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
9505 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, 0, false);
9506 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9507 pixelwidth
, pixelheight
+ FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
));
9510 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
9511 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
9512 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
9513 we have to make sure to do it here. */
9514 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
9516 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
9517 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
9518 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
9519 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
9521 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
9522 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
9523 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
9524 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
9525 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
9527 Pass true for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
9530 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
9531 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
9532 for the ConfigureNotify. */
9533 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9534 x_wait_for_event (f
, ConfigureNotify
);
9537 change_frame_size (f
, width
, height
, false, true, false, true);
9543 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
9544 If CHANGE_GRAVITY, change to top-left-corner window gravity
9545 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
9546 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9549 x_set_window_size (struct frame
*f
, bool change_gravity
,
9550 int width
, int height
, bool pixelwise
)
9554 /* The following breaks our calculations. If it's really needed,
9555 think of something else. */
9557 if (NILP (tip_frame
) || XFRAME (tip_frame
) != f
)
9559 int text_width
, text_height
;
9561 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
9562 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
9563 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/width to
9564 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
9565 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
9566 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
9567 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
9568 int pixelh
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
9569 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9570 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
9572 pixelh
-= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
9574 text_width
= FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_WIDTH (f
, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
));
9575 text_height
= FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_HEIGHT (f
, pixelh
);
9577 change_frame_size (f
, text_width
, text_height
, false, true, false, true);
9582 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
9584 xg_frame_set_char_size (f
, width
* FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
),
9585 height
* FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
));
9587 xg_frame_set_char_size (f
, width
, height
);
9589 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, width
, height
, pixelwise
);
9590 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9592 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, width
, height
, pixelwise
);
9593 x_clear_under_internal_border (f
);
9595 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9597 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
9598 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f
->root_window
));
9600 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
9601 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
9602 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
9603 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
9604 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
9608 do_pending_window_change (false);
9611 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
9614 frame_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame
*f
, int pix_x
, int pix_y
)
9618 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
9619 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x
, pix_y
);
9623 /* Raise frame F. */
9626 x_raise_frame (struct frame
*f
)
9629 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9630 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
9631 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9635 /* Lower frame F. */
9638 x_lower_frame (struct frame
*f
)
9640 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9643 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
9644 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9649 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
9652 xembed_request_focus (struct frame
*f
)
9654 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
9655 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
9656 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9657 xembed_send_message (f
, CurrentTime
,
9658 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
, 0, 0, 0);
9661 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9664 x_ewmh_activate_frame (struct frame
*f
)
9666 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9667 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9669 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9671 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) && wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
))
9674 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9675 x_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
9676 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
,
9678 list2i (1, dpyinfo
->last_user_time
));
9683 XTframe_raise_lower (struct frame
*f
, bool raise_flag
)
9691 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9693 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9695 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9697 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9700 xembed_set_info (struct frame
*f
, enum xembed_info flags
)
9702 unsigned long data
[2];
9703 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9705 data
[0] = XEMBED_VERSION
;
9708 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9709 dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
,
9710 32, PropModeReplace
, (unsigned char *) data
, 2);
9712 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9715 xembed_send_message (struct frame
*f
, Time t
, enum xembed_message msg
,
9716 long int detail
, long int data1
, long int data2
)
9720 event
.xclient
.type
= ClientMessage
;
9721 event
.xclient
.window
= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
;
9722 event
.xclient
.message_type
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_XEMBED
;
9723 event
.xclient
.format
= 32;
9724 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0] = t
;
9725 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1] = msg
;
9726 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[2] = detail
;
9727 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[3] = data1
;
9728 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[4] = data2
;
9730 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
,
9731 False
, NoEventMask
, &event
);
9732 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
9735 /* Change of visibility. */
9737 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9738 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9739 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9740 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9741 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9742 finishes with it. */
9745 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame
*f
)
9747 int original_top
, original_left
;
9752 x_set_bitmap_icon (f
);
9754 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9756 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9757 call x_set_offset a second time
9758 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9759 before the window gets really visible. */
9760 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9761 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
)
9762 && ! f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
)
9763 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
9765 f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
= true;
9767 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
9768 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, NormalState
);
9769 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9770 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9771 xembed_set_info (f
, XEMBED_MAPPED
);
9774 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9775 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9777 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9779 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9780 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
9782 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9783 xembed_set_info (f
, XEMBED_MAPPED
);
9785 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9786 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9787 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9790 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9792 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9793 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9794 so that incoming events are handled. */
9797 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9798 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9799 will set it when they are handled. */
9800 bool previously_visible
= f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
;
9802 original_left
= f
->left_pos
;
9803 original_top
= f
->top_pos
;
9805 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9808 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9810 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9811 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9812 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9813 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9815 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9816 because the window manager may choose the position
9817 and we don't want to override it. */
9819 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
)
9820 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9821 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
)
9822 && f
->win_gravity
== NorthWestGravity
9823 && previously_visible
)
9827 unsigned int width
, height
, border
, depth
;
9831 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9832 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9833 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9834 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9835 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9836 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9837 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9838 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9839 &rootw
, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
, &border
, &depth
);
9841 if (original_left
!= x
|| original_top
!= y
)
9842 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9843 original_left
, original_top
);
9848 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9850 /* Process X events until a MapNotify event has been seen. */
9851 while (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9853 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9856 /* If on another desktop, the deiconify/map may be ignored and the
9857 frame never becomes visible. XMonad does this.
9858 Prevent an endless loop. */
9859 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
) && ++tries
> 100)
9862 /* This hack is still in use at least for Cygwin. See
9863 http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/emacs-devel/2013-12/msg00351.html.
9865 Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9866 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9867 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9868 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9869 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9871 if (input_polling_used ())
9873 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9874 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9875 handler reset it. */
9876 int old_poll_suppress_count
= poll_suppress_count
;
9877 poll_suppress_count
= 1;
9878 poll_for_input_1 ();
9879 poll_suppress_count
= old_poll_suppress_count
;
9882 if (XPending (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)))
9885 XNextEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), &xev
);
9886 x_dispatch_event (&xev
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9892 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9894 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9897 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame
*f
)
9901 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9902 window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9904 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9905 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9906 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9910 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9911 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9912 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9913 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9914 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9915 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, 0, true);
9918 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9919 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9922 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9923 xembed_set_info (f
, 0);
9928 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
,
9929 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))))
9932 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9936 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9937 just by the event that we get from the server.
9938 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9939 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9940 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9941 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
9942 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, false);
9949 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9952 x_iconify_frame (struct frame
*f
)
9954 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9958 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9959 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9960 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9962 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
9967 x_set_bitmap_icon (f
);
9969 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9970 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9972 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9973 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9975 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
9976 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
9977 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, true);
9983 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9985 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9987 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
9988 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
9989 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9990 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9991 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9992 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9993 so we have to record it here. */
9994 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
9995 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, true);
10000 result
= XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
10001 XtWindow (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
),
10002 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)));
10006 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
10008 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, true);
10009 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
10012 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
10014 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10016 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
10017 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
10018 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
)
10019 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
10020 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
10021 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
10023 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
10024 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
10026 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
10027 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
10031 msg
.xclient
.window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
10032 msg
.xclient
.type
= ClientMessage
;
10033 msg
.xclient
.message_type
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_wm_change_state
;
10034 msg
.xclient
.format
= 32;
10035 msg
.xclient
.data
.l
[0] = IconicState
;
10037 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
10038 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)),
10040 SubstructureRedirectMask
| SubstructureNotifyMask
,
10044 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
10048 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
10050 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
10052 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
10054 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
10055 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
10058 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, true);
10059 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
10061 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
10063 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10067 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
10070 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame
*f
)
10072 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
10073 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
10074 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10076 struct scroll_bar
*b
;
10081 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
10082 commands to the X server. */
10083 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
10085 /* Always exit with visible pointer to avoid weird issue
10086 with Xfixes (Bug#17609). */
10087 if (f
->pointer_invisible
)
10088 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->toggle_visible_pointer (f
, 0);
10090 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
10091 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
10093 free_frame_faces (f
);
10095 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
)
10096 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
);
10098 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10099 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
10100 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
10101 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
10102 toolkit scroll bars. */
10103 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); !NILP (bar
); bar
= b
->next
)
10105 b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
10106 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
10112 free_frame_xic (f
);
10115 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10116 if (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
)
10118 XtDestroyWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
10119 f
->output_data
.x
->widget
= NULL
;
10121 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
10122 we are using a toolkit. */
10123 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
10124 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
10126 free_frame_menubar (f
);
10128 if (f
->shell_position
)
10129 xfree (f
->shell_position
);
10130 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10133 xg_free_frame_widgets (f
);
10134 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10136 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
10137 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
10138 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10140 unload_color (f
, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
10141 unload_color (f
, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
10142 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
);
10143 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
);
10144 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
10145 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->mouse_pixel
);
10147 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
!= -1)
10148 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
);
10149 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
10150 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
10151 #if defined (USE_LUCID) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
10152 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
10153 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
10154 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
);
10155 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
10156 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
);
10157 #endif /* USE_LUCID && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10158 if (f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.pixel
!= -1)
10159 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.pixel
);
10160 if (f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.pixel
!= -1)
10161 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.pixel
);
10165 /* Free extra GCs allocated by x_setup_relief_colors. */
10166 if (f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
)
10168 XFreeGC (dpyinfo
->display
, f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
);
10169 f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
= 0;
10171 if (f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
)
10173 XFreeGC (dpyinfo
->display
, f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
);
10174 f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
= 0;
10177 /* Free cursors. */
10178 if (f
->output_data
.x
->text_cursor
!= 0)
10179 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->text_cursor
);
10180 if (f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
!= 0)
10181 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
);
10182 if (f
->output_data
.x
->modeline_cursor
!= 0)
10183 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->modeline_cursor
);
10184 if (f
->output_data
.x
->hand_cursor
!= 0)
10185 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->hand_cursor
);
10186 if (f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_cursor
!= 0)
10187 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_cursor
);
10188 if (f
->output_data
.x
->horizontal_drag_cursor
!= 0)
10189 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->horizontal_drag_cursor
);
10190 if (f
->output_data
.x
->vertical_drag_cursor
!= 0)
10191 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->vertical_drag_cursor
);
10193 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
10196 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
);
10197 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
);
10198 f
->output_data
.x
= NULL
;
10200 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
10201 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= 0;
10202 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
)
10203 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
10204 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
10205 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
10206 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
10207 reset_mouse_highlight (hlinfo
);
10213 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
10216 x_destroy_window (struct frame
*f
)
10218 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
10220 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
10221 commands to the X server. */
10222 if (dpyinfo
->display
!= 0)
10223 x_free_frame_resources (f
);
10225 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
10229 /* Setting window manager hints. */
10231 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
10232 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
10233 that the window now has.
10234 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
10235 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
10236 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
10240 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame
*f
, long flags
, bool user_position
)
10242 XSizeHints size_hints
;
10243 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
10248 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10249 if (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
)
10251 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
10256 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
10257 size_hints
.flags
= PResizeInc
| PMinSize
/* | PMaxSize */;
10259 size_hints
.x
= f
->left_pos
;
10260 size_hints
.y
= f
->top_pos
;
10262 size_hints
.height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
10263 size_hints
.width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
10265 size_hints
.width_inc
= frame_resize_pixelwise
? 1 : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
10266 size_hints
.height_inc
= frame_resize_pixelwise
? 1 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
10268 size_hints
.max_width
= x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
10269 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
10270 size_hints
.max_height
= x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
10271 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
10273 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
10275 int base_width
, base_height
;
10276 int min_rows
= 0, min_cols
= 0;
10278 base_width
= FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
10279 base_height
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
10281 if (frame_resize_pixelwise
)
10282 /* Needed to prevent a bad protocol error crash when making the
10283 frame size very small. */
10285 min_cols
= 2 * min_cols
;
10286 min_rows
= 2 * min_rows
;
10289 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
10290 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
10291 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
10292 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
10293 zero-row, zero-column frame.
10295 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
10296 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
10297 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
10299 size_hints
.flags
|= PBaseSize
;
10300 size_hints
.base_width
= base_width
;
10301 size_hints
.base_height
= base_height
+ FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
10302 size_hints
.min_width
= base_width
+ min_cols
* FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
10303 size_hints
.min_height
= base_height
+ min_rows
* FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
10306 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
10309 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
10314 XSizeHints hints
; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
10315 long supplied_return
;
10318 value
= XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &hints
,
10322 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
10327 if (hints
.flags
& PSize
)
10328 size_hints
.flags
|= PSize
;
10329 if (hints
.flags
& PPosition
)
10330 size_hints
.flags
|= PPosition
;
10331 if (hints
.flags
& USPosition
)
10332 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
10333 if (hints
.flags
& USSize
)
10334 size_hints
.flags
|= USSize
;
10341 size_hints
.win_gravity
= f
->win_gravity
;
10342 size_hints
.flags
|= PWinGravity
;
10346 size_hints
.flags
&= ~ PPosition
;
10347 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
10349 #endif /* PWinGravity */
10351 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &size_hints
);
10353 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
10355 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
10358 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame
*f
, int state
)
10360 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10363 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNinitialState
, state
);
10364 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
10365 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10366 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
10368 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= StateHint
;
10369 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.initial_state
= state
;
10371 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
10372 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10376 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame
*f
, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id
)
10378 Pixmap icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
;
10380 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
10381 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
10386 icon_pixmap
= x_bitmap_pixmap (f
, pixmap_id
);
10387 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_pixmap
= icon_pixmap
;
10388 icon_mask
= x_bitmap_mask (f
, pixmap_id
);
10389 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_mask
= icon_mask
;
10393 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
10401 xg_set_frame_icon (f
, icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
);
10405 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
10409 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconPixmap
, icon_pixmap
);
10410 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
10411 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconMask
, icon_mask
);
10412 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
10415 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10417 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= (IconPixmapHint
| IconMaskHint
);
10418 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
10420 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10424 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame
*f
, int icon_x
, int icon_y
)
10426 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
10428 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= IconPositionHint
;
10429 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_x
= icon_x
;
10430 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_y
= icon_y
;
10432 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
10436 /***********************************************************************
10438 ***********************************************************************/
10442 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
10446 x_check_font (struct frame
*f
, struct font
*font
)
10448 eassert (font
!= NULL
&& ! NILP (font
->props
[FONT_TYPE_INDEX
]));
10449 if (font
->driver
->check
)
10450 eassert (font
->driver
->check (f
, font
) == 0);
10453 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
10456 /***********************************************************************
10458 ***********************************************************************/
10460 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10461 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options
[] = {
10462 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
10463 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg
, (XtPointer
) "yes"},
10465 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10466 XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
10467 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
10469 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10470 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10471 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10472 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10473 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10474 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
10475 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
}
10478 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
10480 static bool x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
;
10482 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10484 static int x_initialized
;
10486 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10487 the screen number from the server number. */
10489 same_x_server (const char *name1
, const char *name2
)
10491 bool seen_colon
= false;
10492 Lisp_Object sysname
= Fsystem_name ();
10493 const char *system_name
= SSDATA (sysname
);
10494 ptrdiff_t system_name_length
= SBYTES (sysname
);
10495 ptrdiff_t length_until_period
= 0;
10497 while (system_name
[length_until_period
] != 0
10498 && system_name
[length_until_period
] != '.')
10499 length_until_period
++;
10501 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10502 if (! strncmp (name1
, "unix:", 5))
10504 if (! strncmp (name2
, "unix:", 5))
10506 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10507 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
10508 && name1
[system_name_length
] == ':')
10509 name1
+= system_name_length
;
10510 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
10511 && name2
[system_name_length
] == ':')
10512 name2
+= system_name_length
;
10513 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10514 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
10515 && name1
[length_until_period
] == ':')
10516 name1
+= length_until_period
;
10517 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
10518 && name2
[length_until_period
] == ':')
10519 name2
+= length_until_period
;
10521 for (; *name1
!= '\0' && *name1
== *name2
; name1
++, name2
++)
10525 if (seen_colon
&& *name1
== '.')
10529 && (*name1
== '.' || *name1
== '\0')
10530 && (*name2
== '.' || *name2
== '\0'));
10533 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10534 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10537 get_bits_and_offset (unsigned long mask
, int *bits
, int *offset
)
10542 while (!(mask
& 1))
10558 /* Return true iff display DISPLAY is available for use.
10559 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
10562 x_display_ok (const char *display
)
10564 Display
*dpy
= XOpenDisplay (display
);
10567 XCloseDisplay (dpy
);
10573 my_log_handler (const gchar
*log_domain
, GLogLevelFlags log_level
,
10574 const gchar
*msg
, gpointer user_data
)
10576 if (!strstr (msg
, "g_set_prgname"))
10577 fprintf (stderr
, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain
, msg
);
10581 /* Create invisible cursor on X display referred by DPYINFO. */
10584 make_invisible_cursor (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
10586 Display
*dpy
= dpyinfo
->display
;
10587 static char const no_data
[] = { 0 };
10592 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
10593 pix
= XCreateBitmapFromData (dpy
, dpyinfo
->root_window
, no_data
, 1, 1);
10594 if (! x_had_errors_p (dpy
) && pix
!= None
)
10598 col
.red
= col
.green
= col
.blue
= 0;
10599 col
.flags
= DoRed
| DoGreen
| DoBlue
;
10600 pixc
= XCreatePixmapCursor (dpy
, pix
, pix
, &col
, &col
, 0, 0);
10601 if (! x_had_errors_p (dpy
) && pixc
!= None
)
10603 XFreePixmap (dpy
, pix
);
10606 x_uncatch_errors ();
10611 /* True if DPY supports Xfixes extension >= 4. */
10614 x_probe_xfixes_extension (Display
*dpy
)
10618 return XFixesQueryVersion (dpy
, &major
, &minor
) && major
>= 4;
10621 #endif /* HAVE_XFIXES */
10624 /* Toggle mouse pointer visibility on frame F by using Xfixes functions. */
10627 xfixes_toggle_visible_pointer (struct frame
*f
, bool invisible
)
10631 XFixesHideCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
10633 XFixesShowCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
10634 f
->pointer_invisible
= invisible
;
10637 #endif /* HAVE_XFIXES */
10640 /* Toggle mouse pointer visibility on frame F by using invisible cursor. */
10643 x_toggle_visible_pointer (struct frame
*f
, bool invisible
)
10645 eassert (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->invisible_cursor
!= 0);
10647 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
10648 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->invisible_cursor
);
10650 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
10651 f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
);
10652 f
->pointer_invisible
= invisible
;
10655 /* Setup pointer blanking, prefer Xfixes if available. */
10658 x_setup_pointer_blanking (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
10660 /* FIXME: the brave tester should set EMACS_XFIXES because we're suspecting
10661 X server bug, see http://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=17609. */
10662 if (egetenv ("EMACS_XFIXES") && x_probe_xfixes_extension (dpyinfo
->display
))
10663 dpyinfo
->toggle_visible_pointer
= xfixes_toggle_visible_pointer
;
10666 dpyinfo
->toggle_visible_pointer
= x_toggle_visible_pointer
;
10667 dpyinfo
->invisible_cursor
= make_invisible_cursor (dpyinfo
);
10671 /* Current X display connection identifier. Incremented for each next
10672 connection established. */
10673 static unsigned x_display_id
;
10675 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
10676 the structure that describes the open display.
10677 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
10679 struct x_display_info
*
10680 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name
, char *xrm_option
, char *resource_name
)
10683 struct terminal
*terminal
;
10684 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
10690 if (!x_initialized
)
10696 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name
)))
10697 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name
));
10701 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10703 char *argv
[NUM_ARGV
];
10704 char **argv2
= argv
;
10707 if (x_initialized
++ > 1)
10709 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name
), &dpy
);
10713 static char display_opt
[] = "--display";
10714 static char name_opt
[] = "--name";
10716 for (argc
= 0; argc
< NUM_ARGV
; ++argc
)
10720 argv
[argc
++] = initial_argv
[0];
10722 if (! NILP (display_name
))
10724 argv
[argc
++] = display_opt
;
10725 argv
[argc
++] = SSDATA (display_name
);
10728 argv
[argc
++] = name_opt
;
10729 argv
[argc
++] = resource_name
;
10731 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10733 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
10734 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
10735 id
= g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING
| G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
10736 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION
, my_log_handler
, NULL
);
10738 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
10739 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
10740 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL
, event_handler_gdk
, NULL
);
10742 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
10744 gtk_init (&argc
, &argv2
);
10747 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id
);
10751 dpy
= DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
10753 #if ! GTK_CHECK_VERSION (2, 90, 0)
10754 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10756 const char *file
= "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10757 Lisp_Object s
, abs_file
;
10759 s
= build_string (file
);
10760 abs_file
= Fexpand_file_name (s
, Qnil
);
10762 if (! NILP (abs_file
) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file
)))
10763 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file
));
10767 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
10768 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
10771 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10772 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10773 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10775 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10776 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10777 So let's not use it until R6. */
10778 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10779 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL
, NULL
, NULL
);
10790 argv
[argc
++] = "-xrm";
10791 argv
[argc
++] = xrm_option
;
10793 turn_on_atimers (false);
10794 dpy
= XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con
, SSDATA (display_name
),
10795 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
,
10796 emacs_options
, XtNumber (emacs_options
),
10798 turn_on_atimers (true);
10800 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10801 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10806 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10807 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10808 dpy
= XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name
));
10809 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10810 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10812 /* Detect failure. */
10819 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10821 dpyinfo
= xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo
);
10822 terminal
= x_create_terminal (dpyinfo
);
10825 struct x_display_info
*share
;
10827 for (share
= x_display_list
; share
; share
= share
->next
)
10828 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (share
->name_list_element
)),
10829 SSDATA (display_name
)))
10832 terminal
->kboard
= share
->terminal
->kboard
;
10835 terminal
->kboard
= allocate_kboard (Qx
);
10837 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
)->function
, Qunbound
))
10839 char *vendor
= ServerVendor (dpy
);
10841 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10842 list of terminals. */
10843 struct gcpro gcpro1
;
10844 Lisp_Object gcpro_term
;
10845 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term
, terminal
);
10846 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term
);
10848 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10849 terminal_list
= terminal
->next_terminal
;
10851 kset_system_key_alist
10853 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
,
10854 vendor
? build_string (vendor
) : empty_unibyte_string
));
10856 terminal
->next_terminal
= terminal_list
;
10857 terminal_list
= terminal
;
10861 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10862 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10863 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10864 if (current_kboard
== initial_kboard
)
10865 current_kboard
= terminal
->kboard
;
10867 terminal
->kboard
->reference_count
++;
10870 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10871 dpyinfo
->next
= x_display_list
;
10872 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
;
10874 dpyinfo
->name_list_element
= Fcons (display_name
, Qnil
);
10875 dpyinfo
->display
= dpy
;
10876 dpyinfo
->connection
= ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo
->display
);
10878 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10879 terminal
->name
= xlispstrdup (display_name
);
10882 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display
, x_trace_wire
);
10885 lim
= min (PTRDIFF_MAX
, SIZE_MAX
) - sizeof "@";
10886 Lisp_Object system_name
= Fsystem_name ();
10887 if (lim
- SBYTES (Vinvocation_name
) < SBYTES (system_name
))
10888 memory_full (SIZE_MAX
);
10889 dpyinfo
->x_id
= ++x_display_id
;
10890 dpyinfo
->x_id_name
= xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name
)
10891 + SBYTES (system_name
) + 2);
10892 char *nametail
= lispstpcpy (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
, Vinvocation_name
);
10894 lispstpcpy (nametail
, system_name
);
10896 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10897 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
10899 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10901 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10902 dpyinfo
->xg_cursor
= xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo
->display
);
10903 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10905 dpyinfo
->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10906 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo
->display
, XC_sb_v_double_arrow
);
10908 dpyinfo
->horizontal_scroll_bar_cursor
10909 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo
->display
, XC_sb_h_double_arrow
);
10911 xrdb
= x_load_resources (dpyinfo
->display
, xrm_option
,
10912 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
);
10913 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10914 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo
->display
, xrdb
);
10916 dpyinfo
->display
->db
= xrdb
;
10918 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10920 dpyinfo
->xrdb
= xrdb
;
10922 dpyinfo
->screen
= ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
,
10923 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo
->display
));
10924 select_visual (dpyinfo
);
10925 dpyinfo
->cmap
= DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10926 dpyinfo
->root_window
= RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10927 dpyinfo
->icon_bitmap_id
= -1;
10928 dpyinfo
->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
10930 reset_mouse_highlight (&dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
);
10932 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10933 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == TrueColor
)
10935 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->red_mask
,
10936 &dpyinfo
->red_bits
, &dpyinfo
->red_offset
);
10937 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->blue_mask
,
10938 &dpyinfo
->blue_bits
, &dpyinfo
->blue_offset
);
10939 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->green_mask
,
10940 &dpyinfo
->green_bits
, &dpyinfo
->green_offset
);
10943 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10944 if (dpyinfo
->visual
== DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
))
10946 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == PseudoColor
)
10948 AUTO_STRING (privateColormap
, "privateColormap");
10949 AUTO_STRING (PrivateColormap
, "PrivateColormap");
10951 = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
, privateColormap
,
10952 PrivateColormap
, Qnil
, Qnil
);
10953 if (STRINGP (value
)
10954 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
10955 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
10956 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->cmap
);
10960 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCreateColormap (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
10961 dpyinfo
->visual
, AllocNone
);
10965 /* If we are using Xft, the following precautions should be made:
10967 1. Make sure that the Xrender extension is added before the Xft one.
10968 Otherwise, the close-display hook set by Xft is called after the one
10969 for Xrender, and the former tries to re-add the latter. This results
10970 in inconsistency of internal states and leads to X protocol error when
10971 one reconnects to the same X server (Bug#1696).
10973 2. Check dpi value in X resources. It is better we use it as well,
10974 since Xft will use it, as will all Gnome applications. If our real DPI
10975 is smaller or larger than the one Xft uses, our font will look smaller
10976 or larger than other for other applications, even if it is the same
10977 font name (monospace-10 for example). */
10979 int event_base
, error_base
;
10983 XRenderQueryExtension (dpyinfo
->display
, &event_base
, &error_base
);
10985 v
= XGetDefault (dpyinfo
->display
, "Xft", "dpi");
10986 if (v
!= NULL
&& sscanf (v
, "%lf", &d
) == 1)
10987 dpyinfo
->resy
= dpyinfo
->resx
= d
;
10991 if (dpyinfo
->resy
< 1)
10993 int screen_number
= XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10994 double pixels
= DisplayHeight (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10995 double mm
= DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10996 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10997 dpyinfo
->resy
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
10998 pixels
= DisplayWidth (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10999 mm
= DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
11000 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
11001 dpyinfo
->resx
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
11005 static const struct
11010 #define ATOM_REFS_INIT(string, member) \
11011 { string, offsetof (struct x_display_info, member) },
11012 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_PROTOCOLS", Xatom_wm_protocols
)
11013 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_TAKE_FOCUS", Xatom_wm_take_focus
)
11014 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", Xatom_wm_save_yourself
)
11015 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_DELETE_WINDOW", Xatom_wm_delete_window
)
11016 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CHANGE_STATE", Xatom_wm_change_state
)
11017 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", Xatom_wm_configure_denied
)
11018 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_MOVED", Xatom_wm_window_moved
)
11019 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CLIENT_LEADER", Xatom_wm_client_leader
)
11020 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("Editres", Xatom_editres
)
11021 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD", Xatom_CLIPBOARD
)
11022 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TIMESTAMP", Xatom_TIMESTAMP
)
11023 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TEXT", Xatom_TEXT
)
11024 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("COMPOUND_TEXT", Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
)
11025 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("UTF8_STRING", Xatom_UTF8_STRING
)
11026 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DELETE", Xatom_DELETE
)
11027 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MULTIPLE", Xatom_MULTIPLE
)
11028 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("INCR", Xatom_INCR
)
11029 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_EMACS_TMP_", Xatom_EMACS_TMP
)
11030 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TARGETS", Xatom_TARGETS
)
11031 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("NULL", Xatom_NULL
)
11032 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM", Xatom_ATOM
)
11033 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM_PAIR", Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
)
11034 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER
)
11035 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED_INFO", Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
)
11036 /* For properties of font. */
11037 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PIXEL_SIZE", Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
)
11038 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("AVERAGE_WIDTH", Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
)
11039 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
)
11040 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
)
11041 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
)
11042 /* Ghostscript support. */
11043 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DONE", Xatom_DONE
)
11044 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PAGE", Xatom_PAGE
)
11045 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Scrollbar
)
11046 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("HORIZONTAL_SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar
)
11047 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED", Xatom_XEMBED
)
11049 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE", Xatom_net_wm_state
)
11050 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
)
11051 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
11052 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
)
11053 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
11054 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
)
11055 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
)
11056 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden
)
11057 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", Xatom_net_window_type
)
11058 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
11059 Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip
)
11060 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_icon_name
)
11061 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_name
)
11062 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTED", Xatom_net_supported
)
11063 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check
)
11064 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
)
11065 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", Xatom_net_active_window
)
11066 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", Xatom_net_frame_extents
)
11067 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_CURRENT_DESKTOP", Xatom_net_current_desktop
)
11068 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WORKAREA", Xatom_net_workarea
)
11069 /* Session management */
11070 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SM_CLIENT_ID", Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID
)
11071 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", Xatom_xsettings_prop
)
11072 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MANAGER", Xatom_xsettings_mgr
)
11076 enum { atom_count
= ARRAYELTS (atom_refs
) };
11077 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN. */
11078 enum { total_atom_count
= 1 + atom_count
};
11079 Atom atoms_return
[total_atom_count
];
11080 char *atom_names
[total_atom_count
];
11081 static char const xsettings_fmt
[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
11082 char xsettings_atom_name
[sizeof xsettings_fmt
- 2
11083 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
11085 for (i
= 0; i
< atom_count
; i
++)
11086 atom_names
[i
] = (char *) atom_refs
[i
].name
;
11088 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name. */
11089 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name
, xsettings_fmt
,
11090 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
));
11091 atom_names
[i
] = xsettings_atom_name
;
11093 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo
->display
, atom_names
, total_atom_count
,
11094 False
, atoms_return
);
11096 for (i
= 0; i
< atom_count
; i
++)
11097 *(Atom
*) ((char *) dpyinfo
+ atom_refs
[i
].offset
) = atoms_return
[i
];
11099 /* Manually copy last atom. */
11100 dpyinfo
->Xatom_xsettings_sel
= atoms_return
[i
];
11103 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
= 8;
11104 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
= xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
11105 * dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
);
11107 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
11108 gray_bits
, gray_width
, gray_height
,
11111 x_setup_pointer_blanking (dpyinfo
);
11114 xim_initialize (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
11117 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo
);
11119 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
11120 if (dpyinfo
->connection
!= 0)
11121 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo
->connection
);
11124 fcntl (dpyinfo
->connection
, F_SETOWN
, getpid ());
11125 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
11127 if (interrupt_input
)
11128 init_sigio (dpyinfo
->connection
);
11132 XrmValue d
, fr
, to
;
11135 dpy
= dpyinfo
->display
;
11136 d
.addr
= (XPointer
)&dpy
;
11137 d
.size
= sizeof (Display
*);
11138 fr
.addr
= XtDefaultFont
;
11139 fr
.size
= sizeof (XtDefaultFont
);
11140 to
.size
= sizeof (Font
*);
11141 to
.addr
= (XPointer
)&font
;
11142 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
11143 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy
, XtCvtStringToFont
, &d
, 1, &fr
, &to
, NULL
))
11145 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
) || !XQueryFont (dpy
, font
))
11146 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb
, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
11147 /* Do not free XFontStruct returned by the above call to XQueryFont.
11148 This leads to X protocol errors at XtCloseDisplay (Bug#18403). */
11149 x_uncatch_errors ();
11153 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
11154 for debugging X code. */
11156 AUTO_STRING (synchronous
, "synchronous");
11157 AUTO_STRING (Synchronous
, "Synchronous");
11158 Lisp_Object value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
, synchronous
,
11159 Synchronous
, Qnil
, Qnil
);
11160 if (STRINGP (value
)
11161 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
11162 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
11163 XSynchronize (dpyinfo
->display
, True
);
11167 AUTO_STRING (useXIM
, "useXIM");
11168 AUTO_STRING (UseXIM
, "UseXIM");
11169 Lisp_Object value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
, useXIM
, UseXIM
,
11172 if (STRINGP (value
)
11173 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "false")
11174 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "off")))
11177 if (STRINGP (value
)
11178 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
11179 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
11185 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
11186 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
11187 tty or started as a daemon. */
11188 if (terminal
->id
== 1 && ! IS_DAEMON
)
11189 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo
);
11197 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
11198 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
11201 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
11203 struct terminal
*t
;
11205 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
11207 for (t
= terminal_list
; t
; t
= t
->next_terminal
)
11208 if (t
->type
== output_x_window
&& t
->display_info
.x
== dpyinfo
)
11211 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
11212 if (t
->id
== 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
11213 x_session_close ();
11215 delete_terminal (t
);
11219 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== dpyinfo
)
11220 next_noop_dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
;
11222 if (x_display_list
== dpyinfo
)
11223 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
->next
;
11226 struct x_display_info
*tail
;
11228 for (tail
= x_display_list
; tail
; tail
= tail
->next
)
11229 if (tail
->next
== dpyinfo
)
11230 tail
->next
= tail
->next
->next
;
11233 xfree (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
);
11234 xfree (dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
);
11235 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
11239 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11241 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
11242 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
11243 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
11244 that slows us down. */
11247 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer
*timer
)
11250 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= false;
11251 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
|| popup_activated ())
11253 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con
) & XtIMTimer
)
11254 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con
, XtIMTimer
);
11255 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
11256 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
11261 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
11262 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
11263 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
11264 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
11265 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
11266 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
11267 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
11270 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
11273 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
)
11275 struct timespec interval
= make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
11276 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE
, interval
, x_process_timeouts
, 0);
11277 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= true;
11282 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11285 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11287 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface
=
11289 x_frame_parm_handlers
,
11293 x_clear_end_of_line
,
11295 x_after_update_window_line
,
11296 x_update_window_begin
,
11297 x_update_window_end
,
11299 x_clear_window_mouse_face
,
11300 x_get_glyph_overhangs
,
11301 x_fix_overlapping_area
,
11302 x_draw_fringe_bitmap
,
11303 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
11304 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
11305 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs
,
11306 x_draw_glyph_string
,
11307 x_define_frame_cursor
,
11308 x_clear_frame_area
,
11309 x_draw_window_cursor
,
11310 x_draw_vertical_window_border
,
11311 x_draw_window_divider
,
11312 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
,
11318 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
11320 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal
*terminal
)
11322 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= terminal
->display_info
.x
;
11324 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
11325 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
11326 if (!terminal
->name
)
11331 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
11334 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo
);
11337 /* Normally, the display is available... */
11338 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
11340 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo
);
11341 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo
->display
, DestroyAll
);
11343 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
11344 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
11345 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
11346 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
11348 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
11349 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
11350 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
11351 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
11352 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
11353 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
11354 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
11355 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
11356 leaks in other situations. */
11358 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
11359 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo
->display
, NULL
);
11361 dpyinfo
->display
->db
= NULL
;
11363 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
11364 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
11365 closing all the displays. */
11366 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo
->xrdb
);
11370 xg_display_close (dpyinfo
->display
);
11372 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11373 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
11375 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
11377 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
11378 /* Do not close the connection here because it's already closed
11379 by X(t)CloseDisplay (Bug#18403). */
11380 dpyinfo
->display
= NULL
;
11383 /* ...but if called from x_connection_closed, the display may already
11384 be closed and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. Since
11385 X server is most likely gone, explicit close is the only reliable
11386 way to continue and avoid Bug#19147. */
11387 else if (dpyinfo
->connection
>= 0)
11388 emacs_close (dpyinfo
->connection
);
11390 /* No more input on this descriptor. */
11391 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo
->connection
);
11392 /* Mark as dead. */
11393 dpyinfo
->connection
= -1;
11395 x_delete_display (dpyinfo
);
11399 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
11400 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
11402 static struct terminal
*
11403 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
11405 struct terminal
*terminal
;
11407 terminal
= create_terminal (output_x_window
, &x_redisplay_interface
);
11409 terminal
->display_info
.x
= dpyinfo
;
11410 dpyinfo
->terminal
= terminal
;
11412 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
11414 terminal
->clear_frame_hook
= x_clear_frame
;
11415 terminal
->ins_del_lines_hook
= x_ins_del_lines
;
11416 terminal
->delete_glyphs_hook
= x_delete_glyphs
;
11417 terminal
->ring_bell_hook
= XTring_bell
;
11418 terminal
->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook
= XTtoggle_invisible_pointer
;
11419 terminal
->update_begin_hook
= x_update_begin
;
11420 terminal
->update_end_hook
= x_update_end
;
11421 terminal
->read_socket_hook
= XTread_socket
;
11422 terminal
->frame_up_to_date_hook
= XTframe_up_to_date
;
11423 terminal
->mouse_position_hook
= XTmouse_position
;
11424 terminal
->frame_rehighlight_hook
= XTframe_rehighlight
;
11425 terminal
->frame_raise_lower_hook
= XTframe_raise_lower
;
11426 terminal
->fullscreen_hook
= XTfullscreen_hook
;
11427 terminal
->menu_show_hook
= x_menu_show
;
11428 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
11429 terminal
->popup_dialog_hook
= xw_popup_dialog
;
11431 terminal
->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook
= XTset_vertical_scroll_bar
;
11432 terminal
->set_horizontal_scroll_bar_hook
= XTset_horizontal_scroll_bar
;
11433 terminal
->condemn_scroll_bars_hook
= XTcondemn_scroll_bars
;
11434 terminal
->redeem_scroll_bar_hook
= XTredeem_scroll_bar
;
11435 terminal
->judge_scroll_bars_hook
= XTjudge_scroll_bars
;
11436 terminal
->delete_frame_hook
= x_destroy_window
;
11437 terminal
->delete_terminal_hook
= x_delete_terminal
;
11438 /* Other hooks are NULL by default. */
11444 x_initialize (void)
11449 any_help_event_p
= false;
11450 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
11453 current_count
= -1;
11456 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
11457 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt
);
11459 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11460 XtToolkitInitialize ();
11462 Xt_app_con
= XtCreateApplicationContext ();
11464 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
11465 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
11466 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con
,
11467 XtRString
, XtRPixel
, cvt_string_to_pixel
,
11468 cvt_string_to_pixel_args
,
11469 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args
),
11470 XtCacheByDisplay
, cvt_pixel_dtor
);
11472 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con
, Xt_default_resources
);
11475 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11477 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= False
;
11478 xaw3d_pick_top
= True
;
11482 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11483 original error handler. */
11484 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
11485 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
11492 /* Emacs can handle only core input events, so make sure
11493 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
11494 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
11499 syms_of_xterm (void)
11501 x_error_message
= NULL
;
11503 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
11504 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1
, "latin-1");
11507 xg_default_icon_file
= build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
11508 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file
);
11510 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock
, "x-gtk-map-stock");
11513 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
11514 x_use_underline_position_properties
,
11515 doc
: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
11516 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
11517 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
11518 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
11519 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
11521 x_use_underline_position_properties
= true;
11523 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
11524 x_underline_at_descent_line
,
11525 doc
: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
11526 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
11527 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
11528 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
11529 x_underline_at_descent_line
= false;
11531 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
11532 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
,
11533 doc
: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
11534 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
11535 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
11536 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
11537 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
11538 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
11539 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
= false;
11541 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
,
11542 doc
: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
11543 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
11544 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
11545 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
11546 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
11547 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11549 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("motif");
11550 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
11551 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
11553 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("gtk");
11555 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("xaw");
11558 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= Qnil
;
11561 DEFSYM (Qmodifier_value
, "modifier-value");
11562 DEFSYM (Qalt
, "alt");
11563 Fput (Qalt
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (alt_modifier
));
11564 DEFSYM (Qhyper
, "hyper");
11565 Fput (Qhyper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (hyper_modifier
));
11566 DEFSYM (Qmeta
, "meta");
11567 Fput (Qmeta
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (meta_modifier
));
11568 DEFSYM (Qsuper
, "super");
11569 Fput (Qsuper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (super_modifier
));
11571 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym
,
11572 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
11573 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11574 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
11575 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
11576 Vx_alt_keysym
= Qnil
;
11578 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym
,
11579 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
11580 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11581 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
11582 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
11583 Vx_hyper_keysym
= Qnil
;
11585 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym
,
11586 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
11587 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11588 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
11589 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
11590 Vx_meta_keysym
= Qnil
;
11592 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym
,
11593 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
11594 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11595 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
11596 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
11597 Vx_super_keysym
= Qnil
;
11599 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table
,
11600 doc
: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
11601 Vx_keysym_table
= make_hash_table (hashtest_eql
, make_number (900),
11602 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE
),
11603 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD
),